1 /* Support routines for Value Range Propagation (VRP).
2 Copyright (C) 2005-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Diego Novillo <dnovillo@redhat.com>.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 #include "coretypes.h"
28 #include "basic-block.h"
29 #include "tree-flow.h"
30 #include "tree-pass.h"
31 #include "tree-dump.h"
32 #include "gimple-pretty-print.h"
33 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
36 #include "tree-scalar-evolution.h"
37 #include "tree-ssa-propagate.h"
38 #include "tree-chrec.h"
39 #include "gimple-fold.h"
44 /* Type of value ranges. See value_range_d for a description of these
46 enum value_range_type
{ VR_UNDEFINED
, VR_RANGE
, VR_ANTI_RANGE
, VR_VARYING
};
48 /* Range of values that can be associated with an SSA_NAME after VRP
52 /* Lattice value represented by this range. */
53 enum value_range_type type
;
55 /* Minimum and maximum values represented by this range. These
56 values should be interpreted as follows:
58 - If TYPE is VR_UNDEFINED or VR_VARYING then MIN and MAX must
61 - If TYPE == VR_RANGE then MIN holds the minimum value and
62 MAX holds the maximum value of the range [MIN, MAX].
64 - If TYPE == ANTI_RANGE the variable is known to NOT
65 take any values in the range [MIN, MAX]. */
69 /* Set of SSA names whose value ranges are equivalent to this one.
70 This set is only valid when TYPE is VR_RANGE or VR_ANTI_RANGE. */
74 typedef struct value_range_d value_range_t
;
76 #define VR_INITIALIZER { VR_UNDEFINED, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE, NULL }
78 /* Set of SSA names found live during the RPO traversal of the function
79 for still active basic-blocks. */
82 /* Return true if the SSA name NAME is live on the edge E. */
85 live_on_edge (edge e
, tree name
)
87 return (live
[e
->dest
->index
]
88 && bitmap_bit_p (live
[e
->dest
->index
], SSA_NAME_VERSION (name
)));
91 /* Local functions. */
92 static int compare_values (tree val1
, tree val2
);
93 static int compare_values_warnv (tree val1
, tree val2
, bool *);
94 static void vrp_meet (value_range_t
*, value_range_t
*);
95 static void vrp_intersect_ranges (value_range_t
*, value_range_t
*);
96 static tree
vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code
,
97 tree
, tree
, bool, bool *,
100 /* Location information for ASSERT_EXPRs. Each instance of this
101 structure describes an ASSERT_EXPR for an SSA name. Since a single
102 SSA name may have more than one assertion associated with it, these
103 locations are kept in a linked list attached to the corresponding
105 struct assert_locus_d
107 /* Basic block where the assertion would be inserted. */
110 /* Some assertions need to be inserted on an edge (e.g., assertions
111 generated by COND_EXPRs). In those cases, BB will be NULL. */
114 /* Pointer to the statement that generated this assertion. */
115 gimple_stmt_iterator si
;
117 /* Predicate code for the ASSERT_EXPR. Must be COMPARISON_CLASS_P. */
118 enum tree_code comp_code
;
120 /* Value being compared against. */
123 /* Expression to compare. */
126 /* Next node in the linked list. */
127 struct assert_locus_d
*next
;
130 typedef struct assert_locus_d
*assert_locus_t
;
132 /* If bit I is present, it means that SSA name N_i has a list of
133 assertions that should be inserted in the IL. */
134 static bitmap need_assert_for
;
136 /* Array of locations lists where to insert assertions. ASSERTS_FOR[I]
137 holds a list of ASSERT_LOCUS_T nodes that describe where
138 ASSERT_EXPRs for SSA name N_I should be inserted. */
139 static assert_locus_t
*asserts_for
;
141 /* Value range array. After propagation, VR_VALUE[I] holds the range
142 of values that SSA name N_I may take. */
143 static unsigned num_vr_values
;
144 static value_range_t
**vr_value
;
145 static bool values_propagated
;
147 /* For a PHI node which sets SSA name N_I, VR_COUNTS[I] holds the
148 number of executable edges we saw the last time we visited the
150 static int *vr_phi_edge_counts
;
157 static vec
<edge
> to_remove_edges
;
158 static vec
<switch_update
> to_update_switch_stmts
;
161 /* Return the maximum value for TYPE. */
164 vrp_val_max (const_tree type
)
166 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
))
169 return TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
172 /* Return the minimum value for TYPE. */
175 vrp_val_min (const_tree type
)
177 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
))
180 return TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
);
183 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the maximum value of its type. This
184 will be true for a positive overflow infinity. We can't do a
185 simple equality comparison with TYPE_MAX_VALUE because C typedefs
186 and Ada subtypes can produce types whose TYPE_MAX_VALUE is not ==
187 to the integer constant with the same value in the type. */
190 vrp_val_is_max (const_tree val
)
192 tree type_max
= vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val
));
193 return (val
== type_max
194 || (type_max
!= NULL_TREE
195 && operand_equal_p (val
, type_max
, 0)));
198 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the minimum value of its type. This
199 will be true for a negative overflow infinity. */
202 vrp_val_is_min (const_tree val
)
204 tree type_min
= vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val
));
205 return (val
== type_min
206 || (type_min
!= NULL_TREE
207 && operand_equal_p (val
, type_min
, 0)));
211 /* Return whether TYPE should use an overflow infinity distinct from
212 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. We use an overflow infinity value to
213 represent a signed overflow during VRP computations. An infinity
214 is distinct from a half-range, which will go from some number to
215 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. */
218 needs_overflow_infinity (const_tree type
)
220 return INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
) && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type
);
223 /* Return whether TYPE can support our overflow infinity
224 representation: we use the TREE_OVERFLOW flag, which only exists
225 for constants. If TYPE doesn't support this, we don't optimize
226 cases which would require signed overflow--we drop them to
230 supports_overflow_infinity (const_tree type
)
232 tree min
= vrp_val_min (type
), max
= vrp_val_max (type
);
233 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
234 gcc_assert (needs_overflow_infinity (type
));
236 return (min
!= NULL_TREE
237 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (min
)
239 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (max
));
242 /* VAL is the maximum or minimum value of a type. Return a
243 corresponding overflow infinity. */
246 make_overflow_infinity (tree val
)
248 gcc_checking_assert (val
!= NULL_TREE
&& CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val
));
249 val
= copy_node (val
);
250 TREE_OVERFLOW (val
) = 1;
254 /* Return a negative overflow infinity for TYPE. */
257 negative_overflow_infinity (tree type
)
259 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type
));
260 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_min (type
));
263 /* Return a positive overflow infinity for TYPE. */
266 positive_overflow_infinity (tree type
)
268 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type
));
269 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_max (type
));
272 /* Return whether VAL is a negative overflow infinity. */
275 is_negative_overflow_infinity (const_tree val
)
277 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val
))
278 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val
)
279 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val
)
280 && vrp_val_is_min (val
));
283 /* Return whether VAL is a positive overflow infinity. */
286 is_positive_overflow_infinity (const_tree val
)
288 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val
))
289 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val
)
290 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val
)
291 && vrp_val_is_max (val
));
294 /* Return whether VAL is a positive or negative overflow infinity. */
297 is_overflow_infinity (const_tree val
)
299 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val
))
300 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val
)
301 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val
)
302 && (vrp_val_is_min (val
) || vrp_val_is_max (val
)));
305 /* Return whether STMT has a constant rhs that is_overflow_infinity. */
308 stmt_overflow_infinity (gimple stmt
)
310 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
)
311 && get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
)) ==
313 return is_overflow_infinity (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
));
317 /* If VAL is now an overflow infinity, return VAL. Otherwise, return
318 the same value with TREE_OVERFLOW clear. This can be used to avoid
319 confusing a regular value with an overflow value. */
322 avoid_overflow_infinity (tree val
)
324 if (!is_overflow_infinity (val
))
327 if (vrp_val_is_max (val
))
328 return vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val
));
331 gcc_checking_assert (vrp_val_is_min (val
));
332 return vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val
));
337 /* Return true if ARG is marked with the nonnull attribute in the
338 current function signature. */
341 nonnull_arg_p (const_tree arg
)
343 tree t
, attrs
, fntype
;
344 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT arg_num
;
346 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (arg
) == PARM_DECL
&& POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg
)));
348 /* The static chain decl is always non null. */
349 if (arg
== cfun
->static_chain_decl
)
352 fntype
= TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl
);
353 for (attrs
= TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (fntype
); attrs
; attrs
= TREE_CHAIN (attrs
))
355 attrs
= lookup_attribute ("nonnull", attrs
);
357 /* If "nonnull" wasn't specified, we know nothing about the argument. */
358 if (attrs
== NULL_TREE
)
361 /* If "nonnull" applies to all the arguments, then ARG is non-null. */
362 if (TREE_VALUE (attrs
) == NULL_TREE
)
365 /* Get the position number for ARG in the function signature. */
366 for (arg_num
= 1, t
= DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl
);
368 t
= DECL_CHAIN (t
), arg_num
++)
374 gcc_assert (t
== arg
);
376 /* Now see if ARG_NUM is mentioned in the nonnull list. */
377 for (t
= TREE_VALUE (attrs
); t
; t
= TREE_CHAIN (t
))
379 if (compare_tree_int (TREE_VALUE (t
), arg_num
) == 0)
388 /* Set value range VR to VR_UNDEFINED. */
391 set_value_range_to_undefined (value_range_t
*vr
)
393 vr
->type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
394 vr
->min
= vr
->max
= NULL_TREE
;
396 bitmap_clear (vr
->equiv
);
400 /* Set value range VR to VR_VARYING. */
403 set_value_range_to_varying (value_range_t
*vr
)
405 vr
->type
= VR_VARYING
;
406 vr
->min
= vr
->max
= NULL_TREE
;
408 bitmap_clear (vr
->equiv
);
412 /* Set value range VR to {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}. */
415 set_value_range (value_range_t
*vr
, enum value_range_type t
, tree min
,
416 tree max
, bitmap equiv
)
418 #if defined ENABLE_CHECKING
419 /* Check the validity of the range. */
420 if (t
== VR_RANGE
|| t
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
424 gcc_assert (min
&& max
);
426 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min
)) && t
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
427 gcc_assert (!vrp_val_is_min (min
) || !vrp_val_is_max (max
));
429 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
430 gcc_assert (cmp
== 0 || cmp
== -1 || cmp
== -2);
432 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (min
)))
433 gcc_assert (!is_overflow_infinity (min
)
434 || !is_overflow_infinity (max
));
437 if (t
== VR_UNDEFINED
|| t
== VR_VARYING
)
438 gcc_assert (min
== NULL_TREE
&& max
== NULL_TREE
);
440 if (t
== VR_UNDEFINED
|| t
== VR_VARYING
)
441 gcc_assert (equiv
== NULL
|| bitmap_empty_p (equiv
));
448 /* Since updating the equivalence set involves deep copying the
449 bitmaps, only do it if absolutely necessary. */
450 if (vr
->equiv
== NULL
452 vr
->equiv
= BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL
);
454 if (equiv
!= vr
->equiv
)
456 if (equiv
&& !bitmap_empty_p (equiv
))
457 bitmap_copy (vr
->equiv
, equiv
);
459 bitmap_clear (vr
->equiv
);
464 /* Set value range VR to the canonical form of {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}.
465 This means adjusting T, MIN and MAX representing the case of a
466 wrapping range with MAX < MIN covering [MIN, type_max] U [type_min, MAX]
467 as anti-rage ~[MAX+1, MIN-1]. Likewise for wrapping anti-ranges.
468 In corner cases where MAX+1 or MIN-1 wraps this will fall back
470 This routine exists to ease canonicalization in the case where we
471 extract ranges from var + CST op limit. */
474 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (value_range_t
*vr
, enum value_range_type t
,
475 tree min
, tree max
, bitmap equiv
)
477 /* Use the canonical setters for VR_UNDEFINED and VR_VARYING. */
478 if (t
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
480 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr
);
483 else if (t
== VR_VARYING
)
485 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
489 /* Nothing to canonicalize for symbolic ranges. */
490 if (TREE_CODE (min
) != INTEGER_CST
491 || TREE_CODE (max
) != INTEGER_CST
)
493 set_value_range (vr
, t
, min
, max
, equiv
);
497 /* Wrong order for min and max, to swap them and the VR type we need
499 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max
, min
))
503 /* For one bit precision if max < min, then the swapped
504 range covers all values, so for VR_RANGE it is varying and
505 for VR_ANTI_RANGE empty range, so drop to varying as well. */
506 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min
)) == 1)
508 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
512 one
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min
), 1);
513 tmp
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, max
, one
);
514 max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, min
, one
);
517 /* There's one corner case, if we had [C+1, C] before we now have
518 that again. But this represents an empty value range, so drop
519 to varying in this case. */
520 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max
, min
))
522 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
526 t
= t
== VR_RANGE
? VR_ANTI_RANGE
: VR_RANGE
;
529 /* Anti-ranges that can be represented as ranges should be so. */
530 if (t
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
532 bool is_min
= vrp_val_is_min (min
);
533 bool is_max
= vrp_val_is_max (max
);
535 if (is_min
&& is_max
)
537 /* We cannot deal with empty ranges, drop to varying.
538 ??? This could be VR_UNDEFINED instead. */
539 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
542 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min
)) == 1
543 && (is_min
|| is_max
))
545 /* Non-empty boolean ranges can always be represented
546 as a singleton range. */
548 min
= max
= vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (min
));
550 min
= max
= vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min
));
554 /* As a special exception preserve non-null ranges. */
555 && !(TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min
))
556 && integer_zerop (max
)))
558 tree one
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max
), 1);
559 min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, max
, one
);
560 max
= vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (max
));
565 tree one
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min
), 1);
566 max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, min
, one
);
567 min
= vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min
));
572 /* Drop [-INF(OVF), +INF(OVF)] to varying. */
573 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (min
))
574 && is_overflow_infinity (min
)
575 && is_overflow_infinity (max
))
577 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
581 set_value_range (vr
, t
, min
, max
, equiv
);
584 /* Copy value range FROM into value range TO. */
587 copy_value_range (value_range_t
*to
, value_range_t
*from
)
589 set_value_range (to
, from
->type
, from
->min
, from
->max
, from
->equiv
);
592 /* Set value range VR to a single value. This function is only called
593 with values we get from statements, and exists to clear the
594 TREE_OVERFLOW flag so that we don't think we have an overflow
595 infinity when we shouldn't. */
598 set_value_range_to_value (value_range_t
*vr
, tree val
, bitmap equiv
)
600 gcc_assert (is_gimple_min_invariant (val
));
601 val
= avoid_overflow_infinity (val
);
602 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, val
, val
, equiv
);
605 /* Set value range VR to a non-negative range of type TYPE.
606 OVERFLOW_INFINITY indicates whether to use an overflow infinity
607 rather than TYPE_MAX_VALUE; this should be true if we determine
608 that the range is nonnegative based on the assumption that signed
609 overflow does not occur. */
612 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (value_range_t
*vr
, tree type
,
613 bool overflow_infinity
)
617 if (overflow_infinity
&& !supports_overflow_infinity (type
))
619 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
623 zero
= build_int_cst (type
, 0);
624 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, zero
,
626 ? positive_overflow_infinity (type
)
627 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
)),
631 /* Set value range VR to a non-NULL range of type TYPE. */
634 set_value_range_to_nonnull (value_range_t
*vr
, tree type
)
636 tree zero
= build_int_cst (type
, 0);
637 set_value_range (vr
, VR_ANTI_RANGE
, zero
, zero
, vr
->equiv
);
641 /* Set value range VR to a NULL range of type TYPE. */
644 set_value_range_to_null (value_range_t
*vr
, tree type
)
646 set_value_range_to_value (vr
, build_int_cst (type
, 0), vr
->equiv
);
650 /* Set value range VR to a range of a truthvalue of type TYPE. */
653 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (value_range_t
*vr
, tree type
)
655 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type
) == 1)
656 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
658 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
,
659 build_int_cst (type
, 0), build_int_cst (type
, 1),
664 /* If abs (min) < abs (max), set VR to [-max, max], if
665 abs (min) >= abs (max), set VR to [-min, min]. */
668 abs_extent_range (value_range_t
*vr
, tree min
, tree max
)
672 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (min
) == INTEGER_CST
);
673 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (max
) == INTEGER_CST
);
674 gcc_assert (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min
)));
675 gcc_assert (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min
)));
676 min
= fold_unary (ABS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (min
), min
);
677 max
= fold_unary (ABS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (max
), max
);
678 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (min
) || TREE_OVERFLOW (max
))
680 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
683 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
685 min
= fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (min
), max
);
686 else if (cmp
== 0 || cmp
== 1)
689 min
= fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (min
), min
);
693 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
696 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, NULL
);
700 /* Return value range information for VAR.
702 If we have no values ranges recorded (ie, VRP is not running), then
703 return NULL. Otherwise create an empty range if none existed for VAR. */
705 static value_range_t
*
706 get_value_range (const_tree var
)
708 static const struct value_range_d vr_const_varying
709 = { VR_VARYING
, NULL_TREE
, NULL_TREE
, NULL
};
712 unsigned ver
= SSA_NAME_VERSION (var
);
714 /* If we have no recorded ranges, then return NULL. */
718 /* If we query the range for a new SSA name return an unmodifiable VARYING.
719 We should get here at most from the substitute-and-fold stage which
720 will never try to change values. */
721 if (ver
>= num_vr_values
)
722 return CONST_CAST (value_range_t
*, &vr_const_varying
);
728 /* After propagation finished do not allocate new value-ranges. */
729 if (values_propagated
)
730 return CONST_CAST (value_range_t
*, &vr_const_varying
);
732 /* Create a default value range. */
733 vr_value
[ver
] = vr
= XCNEW (value_range_t
);
735 /* Defer allocating the equivalence set. */
738 /* If VAR is a default definition of a parameter, the variable can
739 take any value in VAR's type. */
740 if (SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (var
))
742 sym
= SSA_NAME_VAR (var
);
743 if (TREE_CODE (sym
) == PARM_DECL
)
745 /* Try to use the "nonnull" attribute to create ~[0, 0]
746 anti-ranges for pointers. Note that this is only valid with
747 default definitions of PARM_DECLs. */
748 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (sym
))
749 && nonnull_arg_p (sym
))
750 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, TREE_TYPE (sym
));
752 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
754 else if (TREE_CODE (sym
) == RESULT_DECL
755 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (sym
))
756 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, TREE_TYPE (sym
));
762 /* Return true, if VAL1 and VAL2 are equal values for VRP purposes. */
765 vrp_operand_equal_p (const_tree val1
, const_tree val2
)
769 if (!val1
|| !val2
|| !operand_equal_p (val1
, val2
, 0))
771 if (is_overflow_infinity (val1
))
772 return is_overflow_infinity (val2
);
776 /* Return true, if the bitmaps B1 and B2 are equal. */
779 vrp_bitmap_equal_p (const_bitmap b1
, const_bitmap b2
)
782 || ((!b1
|| bitmap_empty_p (b1
))
783 && (!b2
|| bitmap_empty_p (b2
)))
785 && bitmap_equal_p (b1
, b2
)));
788 /* Update the value range and equivalence set for variable VAR to
789 NEW_VR. Return true if NEW_VR is different from VAR's previous
792 NOTE: This function assumes that NEW_VR is a temporary value range
793 object created for the sole purpose of updating VAR's range. The
794 storage used by the equivalence set from NEW_VR will be freed by
795 this function. Do not call update_value_range when NEW_VR
796 is the range object associated with another SSA name. */
799 update_value_range (const_tree var
, value_range_t
*new_vr
)
801 value_range_t
*old_vr
;
804 /* Update the value range, if necessary. */
805 old_vr
= get_value_range (var
);
806 is_new
= old_vr
->type
!= new_vr
->type
807 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr
->min
, new_vr
->min
)
808 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr
->max
, new_vr
->max
)
809 || !vrp_bitmap_equal_p (old_vr
->equiv
, new_vr
->equiv
);
813 /* Do not allow transitions up the lattice. The following
814 is slightly more awkward than just new_vr->type < old_vr->type
815 because VR_RANGE and VR_ANTI_RANGE need to be considered
816 the same. We may not have is_new when transitioning to
817 UNDEFINED or from VARYING. */
818 if (new_vr
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
819 || old_vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
820 set_value_range_to_varying (old_vr
);
822 set_value_range (old_vr
, new_vr
->type
, new_vr
->min
, new_vr
->max
,
826 BITMAP_FREE (new_vr
->equiv
);
832 /* Add VAR and VAR's equivalence set to EQUIV. This is the central
833 point where equivalence processing can be turned on/off. */
836 add_equivalence (bitmap
*equiv
, const_tree var
)
838 unsigned ver
= SSA_NAME_VERSION (var
);
839 value_range_t
*vr
= vr_value
[ver
];
842 *equiv
= BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL
);
843 bitmap_set_bit (*equiv
, ver
);
845 bitmap_ior_into (*equiv
, vr
->equiv
);
849 /* Return true if VR is ~[0, 0]. */
852 range_is_nonnull (value_range_t
*vr
)
854 return vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
855 && integer_zerop (vr
->min
)
856 && integer_zerop (vr
->max
);
860 /* Return true if VR is [0, 0]. */
863 range_is_null (value_range_t
*vr
)
865 return vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
866 && integer_zerop (vr
->min
)
867 && integer_zerop (vr
->max
);
870 /* Return true if max and min of VR are INTEGER_CST. It's not necessary
874 range_int_cst_p (value_range_t
*vr
)
876 return (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
877 && TREE_CODE (vr
->max
) == INTEGER_CST
878 && TREE_CODE (vr
->min
) == INTEGER_CST
);
881 /* Return true if VR is a INTEGER_CST singleton. */
884 range_int_cst_singleton_p (value_range_t
*vr
)
886 return (range_int_cst_p (vr
)
887 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (vr
->min
)
888 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (vr
->max
)
889 && tree_int_cst_equal (vr
->min
, vr
->max
));
892 /* Return true if value range VR involves at least one symbol. */
895 symbolic_range_p (value_range_t
*vr
)
897 return (!is_gimple_min_invariant (vr
->min
)
898 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (vr
->max
));
901 /* Return true if value range VR uses an overflow infinity. */
904 overflow_infinity_range_p (value_range_t
*vr
)
906 return (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
907 && (is_overflow_infinity (vr
->min
)
908 || is_overflow_infinity (vr
->max
)));
911 /* Return false if we can not make a valid comparison based on VR;
912 this will be the case if it uses an overflow infinity and overflow
913 is not undefined (i.e., -fno-strict-overflow is in effect).
914 Otherwise return true, and set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true if VR
915 uses an overflow infinity. */
918 usable_range_p (value_range_t
*vr
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
920 gcc_assert (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
);
921 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr
->min
))
923 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
924 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr
->min
)))
927 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr
->max
))
929 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
930 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr
->max
)))
937 /* Return true if the result of assignment STMT is know to be non-negative.
938 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
939 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
940 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
943 gimple_assign_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
945 enum tree_code code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
946 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (code
))
948 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
:
949 return tree_unary_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
950 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
951 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
953 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
:
954 return tree_binary_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
955 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
956 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
957 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
),
959 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS
:
961 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
:
962 return tree_single_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
964 case GIMPLE_INVALID_RHS
:
971 /* Return true if return value of call STMT is know to be non-negative.
972 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
973 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
974 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
977 gimple_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
979 tree arg0
= gimple_call_num_args (stmt
) > 0 ?
980 gimple_call_arg (stmt
, 0) : NULL_TREE
;
981 tree arg1
= gimple_call_num_args (stmt
) > 1 ?
982 gimple_call_arg (stmt
, 1) : NULL_TREE
;
984 return tree_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
985 gimple_call_fndecl (stmt
),
991 /* Return true if STMT is know to to compute a non-negative value.
992 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
993 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
994 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
997 gimple_stmt_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
999 switch (gimple_code (stmt
))
1002 return gimple_assign_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt
, strict_overflow_p
);
1004 return gimple_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt
, strict_overflow_p
);
1010 /* Return true if the result of assignment STMT is know to be non-zero.
1011 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1012 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1013 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1016 gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
1018 enum tree_code code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
1019 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (code
))
1021 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
:
1022 return tree_unary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
1023 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
1024 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
1026 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
:
1027 return tree_binary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
1028 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
1029 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
1030 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
),
1032 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS
:
1034 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
:
1035 return tree_single_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
1037 case GIMPLE_INVALID_RHS
:
1044 /* Return true if STMT is know to to compute a non-zero value.
1045 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1046 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1047 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1050 gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
1052 switch (gimple_code (stmt
))
1055 return gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt
, strict_overflow_p
);
1057 return gimple_alloca_call_p (stmt
);
1063 /* Like tree_expr_nonzero_warnv_p, but this function uses value ranges
1067 vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (gimple stmt
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
1069 if (gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt
, strict_overflow_p
))
1072 /* If we have an expression of the form &X->a, then the expression
1073 is nonnull if X is nonnull. */
1074 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
)
1075 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
) == ADDR_EXPR
)
1077 tree expr
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
1078 tree base
= get_base_address (TREE_OPERAND (expr
, 0));
1080 if (base
!= NULL_TREE
1081 && TREE_CODE (base
) == MEM_REF
1082 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (base
, 0)) == SSA_NAME
)
1084 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (TREE_OPERAND (base
, 0));
1085 if (range_is_nonnull (vr
))
1093 /* Returns true if EXPR is a valid value (as expected by compare_values) --
1094 a gimple invariant, or SSA_NAME +- CST. */
1097 valid_value_p (tree expr
)
1099 if (TREE_CODE (expr
) == SSA_NAME
)
1102 if (TREE_CODE (expr
) == PLUS_EXPR
1103 || TREE_CODE (expr
) == MINUS_EXPR
)
1104 return (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr
, 0)) == SSA_NAME
1105 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr
, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
);
1107 return is_gimple_min_invariant (expr
);
1113 -2 if those are incomparable. */
1115 operand_less_p (tree val
, tree val2
)
1117 /* LT is folded faster than GE and others. Inline the common case. */
1118 if (TREE_CODE (val
) == INTEGER_CST
&& TREE_CODE (val2
) == INTEGER_CST
)
1120 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
1121 return INT_CST_LT_UNSIGNED (val
, val2
);
1124 if (INT_CST_LT (val
, val2
))
1132 fold_defer_overflow_warnings ();
1134 tcmp
= fold_binary_to_constant (LT_EXPR
, boolean_type_node
, val
, val2
);
1136 fold_undefer_and_ignore_overflow_warnings ();
1139 || TREE_CODE (tcmp
) != INTEGER_CST
)
1142 if (!integer_zerop (tcmp
))
1146 /* val >= val2, not considering overflow infinity. */
1147 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val
))
1148 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2
) ? 0 : 1;
1149 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2
))
1150 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val
) ? 0 : 1;
1155 /* Compare two values VAL1 and VAL2. Return
1157 -2 if VAL1 and VAL2 cannot be compared at compile-time,
1160 +1 if VAL1 > VAL2, and
1163 This is similar to tree_int_cst_compare but supports pointer values
1164 and values that cannot be compared at compile time.
1166 If STRICT_OVERFLOW_P is not NULL, then set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to
1167 true if the return value is only valid if we assume that signed
1168 overflow is undefined. */
1171 compare_values_warnv (tree val1
, tree val2
, bool *strict_overflow_p
)
1176 /* Below we rely on the fact that VAL1 and VAL2 are both pointers or
1178 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1
))
1179 == POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val2
)));
1180 /* Convert the two values into the same type. This is needed because
1181 sizetype causes sign extension even for unsigned types. */
1182 val2
= fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (val1
), val2
);
1183 STRIP_USELESS_TYPE_CONVERSION (val2
);
1185 if ((TREE_CODE (val1
) == SSA_NAME
1186 || TREE_CODE (val1
) == PLUS_EXPR
1187 || TREE_CODE (val1
) == MINUS_EXPR
)
1188 && (TREE_CODE (val2
) == SSA_NAME
1189 || TREE_CODE (val2
) == PLUS_EXPR
1190 || TREE_CODE (val2
) == MINUS_EXPR
))
1192 tree n1
, c1
, n2
, c2
;
1193 enum tree_code code1
, code2
;
1195 /* If VAL1 and VAL2 are of the form 'NAME [+-] CST' or 'NAME',
1196 return -1 or +1 accordingly. If VAL1 and VAL2 don't use the
1197 same name, return -2. */
1198 if (TREE_CODE (val1
) == SSA_NAME
)
1206 code1
= TREE_CODE (val1
);
1207 n1
= TREE_OPERAND (val1
, 0);
1208 c1
= TREE_OPERAND (val1
, 1);
1209 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (c1
) == -1)
1211 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (c1
))
1213 c1
= fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (c1
), c1
);
1216 code1
= code1
== MINUS_EXPR
? PLUS_EXPR
: MINUS_EXPR
;
1220 if (TREE_CODE (val2
) == SSA_NAME
)
1228 code2
= TREE_CODE (val2
);
1229 n2
= TREE_OPERAND (val2
, 0);
1230 c2
= TREE_OPERAND (val2
, 1);
1231 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (c2
) == -1)
1233 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (c2
))
1235 c2
= fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (c2
), c2
);
1238 code2
= code2
== MINUS_EXPR
? PLUS_EXPR
: MINUS_EXPR
;
1242 /* Both values must use the same name. */
1246 if (code1
== SSA_NAME
1247 && code2
== SSA_NAME
)
1251 /* If overflow is defined we cannot simplify more. */
1252 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (val1
)))
1255 if (strict_overflow_p
!= NULL
1256 && (code1
== SSA_NAME
|| !TREE_NO_WARNING (val1
))
1257 && (code2
== SSA_NAME
|| !TREE_NO_WARNING (val2
)))
1258 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
1260 if (code1
== SSA_NAME
)
1262 if (code2
== PLUS_EXPR
)
1263 /* NAME < NAME + CST */
1265 else if (code2
== MINUS_EXPR
)
1266 /* NAME > NAME - CST */
1269 else if (code1
== PLUS_EXPR
)
1271 if (code2
== SSA_NAME
)
1272 /* NAME + CST > NAME */
1274 else if (code2
== PLUS_EXPR
)
1275 /* NAME + CST1 > NAME + CST2, if CST1 > CST2 */
1276 return compare_values_warnv (c1
, c2
, strict_overflow_p
);
1277 else if (code2
== MINUS_EXPR
)
1278 /* NAME + CST1 > NAME - CST2 */
1281 else if (code1
== MINUS_EXPR
)
1283 if (code2
== SSA_NAME
)
1284 /* NAME - CST < NAME */
1286 else if (code2
== PLUS_EXPR
)
1287 /* NAME - CST1 < NAME + CST2 */
1289 else if (code2
== MINUS_EXPR
)
1290 /* NAME - CST1 > NAME - CST2, if CST1 < CST2. Notice that
1291 C1 and C2 are swapped in the call to compare_values. */
1292 return compare_values_warnv (c2
, c1
, strict_overflow_p
);
1298 /* We cannot compare non-constants. */
1299 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val1
) || !is_gimple_min_invariant (val2
))
1302 if (!POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1
)))
1304 /* We cannot compare overflowed values, except for overflow
1306 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (val1
) || TREE_OVERFLOW (val2
))
1308 if (strict_overflow_p
!= NULL
)
1309 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
1310 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val1
))
1311 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2
) ? 0 : -1;
1312 else if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2
))
1314 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val1
))
1315 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2
) ? 0 : 1;
1316 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2
))
1321 return tree_int_cst_compare (val1
, val2
);
1327 /* First see if VAL1 and VAL2 are not the same. */
1328 if (val1
== val2
|| operand_equal_p (val1
, val2
, 0))
1331 /* If VAL1 is a lower address than VAL2, return -1. */
1332 if (operand_less_p (val1
, val2
) == 1)
1335 /* If VAL1 is a higher address than VAL2, return +1. */
1336 if (operand_less_p (val2
, val1
) == 1)
1339 /* If VAL1 is different than VAL2, return +2.
1340 For integer constants we either have already returned -1 or 1
1341 or they are equivalent. We still might succeed in proving
1342 something about non-trivial operands. */
1343 if (TREE_CODE (val1
) != INTEGER_CST
1344 || TREE_CODE (val2
) != INTEGER_CST
)
1346 t
= fold_binary_to_constant (NE_EXPR
, boolean_type_node
, val1
, val2
);
1347 if (t
&& integer_onep (t
))
1355 /* Compare values like compare_values_warnv, but treat comparisons of
1356 nonconstants which rely on undefined overflow as incomparable. */
1359 compare_values (tree val1
, tree val2
)
1365 ret
= compare_values_warnv (val1
, val2
, &sop
);
1367 && (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val1
) || !is_gimple_min_invariant (val2
)))
1373 /* Return 1 if VAL is inside value range MIN <= VAL <= MAX,
1374 0 if VAL is not inside [MIN, MAX],
1375 -2 if we cannot tell either way.
1377 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1381 value_inside_range (tree val
, tree min
, tree max
)
1385 cmp1
= operand_less_p (val
, min
);
1391 cmp2
= operand_less_p (max
, val
);
1399 /* Return true if value ranges VR0 and VR1 have a non-empty
1402 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1407 value_ranges_intersect_p (value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
1409 /* The value ranges do not intersect if the maximum of the first range is
1410 less than the minimum of the second range or vice versa.
1411 When those relations are unknown, we can't do any better. */
1412 if (operand_less_p (vr0
->max
, vr1
->min
) != 0)
1414 if (operand_less_p (vr1
->max
, vr0
->min
) != 0)
1420 /* Return 1 if [MIN, MAX] includes the value zero, 0 if it does not
1421 include the value zero, -2 if we cannot tell. */
1424 range_includes_zero_p (tree min
, tree max
)
1426 tree zero
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min
), 0);
1427 return value_inside_range (zero
, min
, max
);
1430 /* Return true if *VR is know to only contain nonnegative values. */
1433 value_range_nonnegative_p (value_range_t
*vr
)
1435 /* Testing for VR_ANTI_RANGE is not useful here as any anti-range
1436 which would return a useful value should be encoded as a
1438 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
)
1440 int result
= compare_values (vr
->min
, integer_zero_node
);
1441 return (result
== 0 || result
== 1);
1447 /* Return true if T, an SSA_NAME, is known to be nonnegative. Return
1448 false otherwise or if no value range information is available. */
1451 ssa_name_nonnegative_p (const_tree t
)
1453 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (t
);
1455 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (t
)
1456 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t
))
1462 return value_range_nonnegative_p (vr
);
1465 /* If *VR has a value rante that is a single constant value return that,
1466 otherwise return NULL_TREE. */
1469 value_range_constant_singleton (value_range_t
*vr
)
1471 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
1472 && operand_equal_p (vr
->min
, vr
->max
, 0)
1473 && is_gimple_min_invariant (vr
->min
))
1479 /* If OP has a value range with a single constant value return that,
1480 otherwise return NULL_TREE. This returns OP itself if OP is a
1484 op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (tree op
)
1486 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op
))
1489 if (TREE_CODE (op
) != SSA_NAME
)
1492 return value_range_constant_singleton (get_value_range (op
));
1495 /* Return true if op is in a boolean [0, 1] value-range. */
1498 op_with_boolean_value_range_p (tree op
)
1502 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op
)) == 1)
1505 if (integer_zerop (op
)
1506 || integer_onep (op
))
1509 if (TREE_CODE (op
) != SSA_NAME
)
1512 vr
= get_value_range (op
);
1513 return (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
1514 && integer_zerop (vr
->min
)
1515 && integer_onep (vr
->max
));
1518 /* Extract value range information from an ASSERT_EXPR EXPR and store
1522 extract_range_from_assert (value_range_t
*vr_p
, tree expr
)
1524 tree var
, cond
, limit
, min
, max
, type
;
1525 value_range_t
*limit_vr
;
1526 enum tree_code cond_code
;
1528 var
= ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (expr
);
1529 cond
= ASSERT_EXPR_COND (expr
);
1531 gcc_assert (COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond
));
1533 /* Find VAR in the ASSERT_EXPR conditional. */
1534 if (var
== TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0)
1535 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
1536 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0)) == NOP_EXPR
)
1538 /* If the predicate is of the form VAR COMP LIMIT, then we just
1539 take LIMIT from the RHS and use the same comparison code. */
1540 cond_code
= TREE_CODE (cond
);
1541 limit
= TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 1);
1542 cond
= TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0);
1546 /* If the predicate is of the form LIMIT COMP VAR, then we need
1547 to flip around the comparison code to create the proper range
1549 cond_code
= swap_tree_comparison (TREE_CODE (cond
));
1550 limit
= TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0);
1551 cond
= TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 1);
1554 limit
= avoid_overflow_infinity (limit
);
1556 type
= TREE_TYPE (var
);
1557 gcc_assert (limit
!= var
);
1559 /* For pointer arithmetic, we only keep track of pointer equality
1561 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type
) && cond_code
!= NE_EXPR
&& cond_code
!= EQ_EXPR
)
1563 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p
);
1567 /* If LIMIT is another SSA name and LIMIT has a range of its own,
1568 try to use LIMIT's range to avoid creating symbolic ranges
1570 limit_vr
= (TREE_CODE (limit
) == SSA_NAME
) ? get_value_range (limit
) : NULL
;
1572 /* LIMIT's range is only interesting if it has any useful information. */
1574 && (limit_vr
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
1575 || limit_vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
1576 || symbolic_range_p (limit_vr
)))
1579 /* Initially, the new range has the same set of equivalences of
1580 VAR's range. This will be revised before returning the final
1581 value. Since assertions may be chained via mutually exclusive
1582 predicates, we will need to trim the set of equivalences before
1584 gcc_assert (vr_p
->equiv
== NULL
);
1585 add_equivalence (&vr_p
->equiv
, var
);
1587 /* Extract a new range based on the asserted comparison for VAR and
1588 LIMIT's value range. Notice that if LIMIT has an anti-range, we
1589 will only use it for equality comparisons (EQ_EXPR). For any
1590 other kind of assertion, we cannot derive a range from LIMIT's
1591 anti-range that can be used to describe the new range. For
1592 instance, ASSERT_EXPR <x_2, x_2 <= b_4>. If b_4 is ~[2, 10],
1593 then b_4 takes on the ranges [-INF, 1] and [11, +INF]. There is
1594 no single range for x_2 that could describe LE_EXPR, so we might
1595 as well build the range [b_4, +INF] for it.
1596 One special case we handle is extracting a range from a
1597 range test encoded as (unsigned)var + CST <= limit. */
1598 if (TREE_CODE (cond
) == NOP_EXPR
1599 || TREE_CODE (cond
) == PLUS_EXPR
)
1601 if (TREE_CODE (cond
) == PLUS_EXPR
)
1603 min
= fold_build1 (NEGATE_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 1)),
1604 TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 1));
1605 max
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, limit
, min
);
1606 cond
= TREE_OPERAND (cond
, 0);
1610 min
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (var
), 0);
1614 /* Make sure to not set TREE_OVERFLOW on the final type
1615 conversion. We are willingly interpreting large positive
1616 unsigned values as negative singed values here. */
1617 min
= force_fit_type_double (TREE_TYPE (var
), tree_to_double_int (min
),
1619 max
= force_fit_type_double (TREE_TYPE (var
), tree_to_double_int (max
),
1622 /* We can transform a max, min range to an anti-range or
1623 vice-versa. Use set_and_canonicalize_value_range which does
1625 if (cond_code
== LE_EXPR
)
1626 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p
, VR_RANGE
,
1627 min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1628 else if (cond_code
== GT_EXPR
)
1629 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p
, VR_ANTI_RANGE
,
1630 min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1634 else if (cond_code
== EQ_EXPR
)
1636 enum value_range_type range_type
;
1640 range_type
= limit_vr
->type
;
1641 min
= limit_vr
->min
;
1642 max
= limit_vr
->max
;
1646 range_type
= VR_RANGE
;
1651 set_value_range (vr_p
, range_type
, min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1653 /* When asserting the equality VAR == LIMIT and LIMIT is another
1654 SSA name, the new range will also inherit the equivalence set
1656 if (TREE_CODE (limit
) == SSA_NAME
)
1657 add_equivalence (&vr_p
->equiv
, limit
);
1659 else if (cond_code
== NE_EXPR
)
1661 /* As described above, when LIMIT's range is an anti-range and
1662 this assertion is an inequality (NE_EXPR), then we cannot
1663 derive anything from the anti-range. For instance, if
1664 LIMIT's range was ~[0, 0], the assertion 'VAR != LIMIT' does
1665 not imply that VAR's range is [0, 0]. So, in the case of
1666 anti-ranges, we just assert the inequality using LIMIT and
1669 If LIMIT_VR is a range, we can only use it to build a new
1670 anti-range if LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range. For
1671 instance, if LIMIT_VR is [0, 1], the predicate
1672 VAR != [0, 1] does not mean that VAR's range is ~[0, 1].
1673 Rather, it means that for value 0 VAR should be ~[0, 0]
1674 and for value 1, VAR should be ~[1, 1]. We cannot
1675 represent these ranges.
1677 The only situation in which we can build a valid
1678 anti-range is when LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range
1679 (i.e., LIMIT_VR->MIN == LIMIT_VR->MAX). In that case,
1680 build the anti-range ~[LIMIT_VR->MIN, LIMIT_VR->MAX]. */
1682 && limit_vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
1683 && compare_values (limit_vr
->min
, limit_vr
->max
) == 0)
1685 min
= limit_vr
->min
;
1686 max
= limit_vr
->max
;
1690 /* In any other case, we cannot use LIMIT's range to build a
1691 valid anti-range. */
1695 /* If MIN and MAX cover the whole range for their type, then
1696 just use the original LIMIT. */
1697 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
1698 && vrp_val_is_min (min
)
1699 && vrp_val_is_max (max
))
1702 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p
, VR_ANTI_RANGE
,
1703 min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1705 else if (cond_code
== LE_EXPR
|| cond_code
== LT_EXPR
)
1707 min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
);
1709 if (limit_vr
== NULL
|| limit_vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
1713 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1714 range [MIN, N2] for LE_EXPR and [MIN, N2 - 1] for
1716 max
= limit_vr
->max
;
1719 /* If the maximum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1720 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1721 all should be optimized away above us. */
1722 if ((cond_code
== LT_EXPR
1723 && compare_values (max
, min
) == 0)
1724 || (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (max
) && TREE_OVERFLOW (max
)))
1725 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p
);
1728 /* For LT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN, MAX - 1]. */
1729 if (cond_code
== LT_EXPR
)
1731 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (max
)) == 1
1732 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (max
)))
1733 max
= fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (max
), max
,
1734 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max
), -1));
1736 max
= fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (max
), max
,
1737 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max
), 1));
1739 TREE_NO_WARNING (max
) = 1;
1742 set_value_range (vr_p
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1745 else if (cond_code
== GE_EXPR
|| cond_code
== GT_EXPR
)
1747 max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
1749 if (limit_vr
== NULL
|| limit_vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
1753 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1754 range [N1, MAX] for GE_EXPR and [N1 + 1, MAX] for
1756 min
= limit_vr
->min
;
1759 /* If the minimum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1760 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1761 all should be optimized away above us. */
1762 if ((cond_code
== GT_EXPR
1763 && compare_values (min
, max
) == 0)
1764 || (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (min
) && TREE_OVERFLOW (min
)))
1765 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p
);
1768 /* For GT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN + 1, MAX]. */
1769 if (cond_code
== GT_EXPR
)
1771 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min
)) == 1
1772 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min
)))
1773 min
= fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (min
), min
,
1774 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min
), -1));
1776 min
= fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (min
), min
,
1777 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min
), 1));
1779 TREE_NO_WARNING (min
) = 1;
1782 set_value_range (vr_p
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, vr_p
->equiv
);
1788 /* Finally intersect the new range with what we already know about var. */
1789 vrp_intersect_ranges (vr_p
, get_value_range (var
));
1793 /* Extract range information from SSA name VAR and store it in VR. If
1794 VAR has an interesting range, use it. Otherwise, create the
1795 range [VAR, VAR] and return it. This is useful in situations where
1796 we may have conditionals testing values of VARYING names. For
1803 Even if y_5 is deemed VARYING, we can determine that x_3 > y_5 is
1807 extract_range_from_ssa_name (value_range_t
*vr
, tree var
)
1809 value_range_t
*var_vr
= get_value_range (var
);
1811 if (var_vr
->type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
&& var_vr
->type
!= VR_VARYING
)
1812 copy_value_range (vr
, var_vr
);
1814 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, var
, var
, NULL
);
1816 add_equivalence (&vr
->equiv
, var
);
1820 /* Wrapper around int_const_binop. If the operation overflows and we
1821 are not using wrapping arithmetic, then adjust the result to be
1822 -INF or +INF depending on CODE, VAL1 and VAL2. This can return
1823 NULL_TREE if we need to use an overflow infinity representation but
1824 the type does not support it. */
1827 vrp_int_const_binop (enum tree_code code
, tree val1
, tree val2
)
1831 res
= int_const_binop (code
, val1
, val2
);
1833 /* If we are using unsigned arithmetic, operate symbolically
1834 on -INF and +INF as int_const_binop only handles signed overflow. */
1835 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val1
)))
1837 int checkz
= compare_values (res
, val1
);
1838 bool overflow
= false;
1840 /* Ensure that res = val1 [+*] val2 >= val1
1841 or that res = val1 - val2 <= val1. */
1842 if ((code
== PLUS_EXPR
1843 && !(checkz
== 1 || checkz
== 0))
1844 || (code
== MINUS_EXPR
1845 && !(checkz
== 0 || checkz
== -1)))
1849 /* Checking for multiplication overflow is done by dividing the
1850 output of the multiplication by the first input of the
1851 multiplication. If the result of that division operation is
1852 not equal to the second input of the multiplication, then the
1853 multiplication overflowed. */
1854 else if (code
== MULT_EXPR
&& !integer_zerop (val1
))
1856 tree tmp
= int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
,
1859 int check
= compare_values (tmp
, val2
);
1867 res
= copy_node (res
);
1868 TREE_OVERFLOW (res
) = 1;
1872 else if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (TREE_TYPE (val1
)))
1873 /* If the singed operation wraps then int_const_binop has done
1874 everything we want. */
1876 else if ((TREE_OVERFLOW (res
)
1877 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val1
)
1878 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val2
))
1879 || is_overflow_infinity (val1
)
1880 || is_overflow_infinity (val2
))
1882 /* If the operation overflowed but neither VAL1 nor VAL2 are
1883 overflown, return -INF or +INF depending on the operation
1884 and the combination of signs of the operands. */
1885 int sgn1
= tree_int_cst_sgn (val1
);
1886 int sgn2
= tree_int_cst_sgn (val2
);
1888 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
))
1889 && !supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
)))
1892 /* We have to punt on adding infinities of different signs,
1893 since we can't tell what the sign of the result should be.
1894 Likewise for subtracting infinities of the same sign. */
1895 if (((code
== PLUS_EXPR
&& sgn1
!= sgn2
)
1896 || (code
== MINUS_EXPR
&& sgn1
== sgn2
))
1897 && is_overflow_infinity (val1
)
1898 && is_overflow_infinity (val2
))
1901 /* Don't try to handle division or shifting of infinities. */
1902 if ((code
== TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1903 || code
== FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1904 || code
== CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1905 || code
== EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1906 || code
== ROUND_DIV_EXPR
1907 || code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
)
1908 && (is_overflow_infinity (val1
)
1909 || is_overflow_infinity (val2
)))
1912 /* Notice that we only need to handle the restricted set of
1913 operations handled by extract_range_from_binary_expr.
1914 Among them, only multiplication, addition and subtraction
1915 can yield overflow without overflown operands because we
1916 are working with integral types only... except in the
1917 case VAL1 = -INF and VAL2 = -1 which overflows to +INF
1918 for division too. */
1920 /* For multiplication, the sign of the overflow is given
1921 by the comparison of the signs of the operands. */
1922 if ((code
== MULT_EXPR
&& sgn1
== sgn2
)
1923 /* For addition, the operands must be of the same sign
1924 to yield an overflow. Its sign is therefore that
1925 of one of the operands, for example the first. For
1926 infinite operands X + -INF is negative, not positive. */
1927 || (code
== PLUS_EXPR
1929 ? !is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2
)
1930 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2
)))
1931 /* For subtraction, non-infinite operands must be of
1932 different signs to yield an overflow. Its sign is
1933 therefore that of the first operand or the opposite of
1934 that of the second operand. A first operand of 0 counts
1935 as positive here, for the corner case 0 - (-INF), which
1936 overflows, but must yield +INF. For infinite operands 0
1937 - INF is negative, not positive. */
1938 || (code
== MINUS_EXPR
1940 ? !is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2
)
1941 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2
)))
1942 /* We only get in here with positive shift count, so the
1943 overflow direction is the same as the sign of val1.
1944 Actually rshift does not overflow at all, but we only
1945 handle the case of shifting overflowed -INF and +INF. */
1946 || (code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
1948 /* For division, the only case is -INF / -1 = +INF. */
1949 || code
== TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1950 || code
== FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1951 || code
== CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1952 || code
== EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1953 || code
== ROUND_DIV_EXPR
)
1954 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
))
1955 ? positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
))
1956 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res
)));
1958 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
))
1959 ? negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res
))
1960 : TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res
)));
1967 /* For range VR compute two double_int bitmasks. In *MAY_BE_NONZERO
1968 bitmask if some bit is unset, it means for all numbers in the range
1969 the bit is 0, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. In *MUST_BE_NONZERO
1970 bitmask if some bit is set, it means for all numbers in the range
1971 the bit is 1, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. */
1974 zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (value_range_t
*vr
,
1975 double_int
*may_be_nonzero
,
1976 double_int
*must_be_nonzero
)
1978 *may_be_nonzero
= double_int_minus_one
;
1979 *must_be_nonzero
= double_int_zero
;
1980 if (!range_int_cst_p (vr
)
1981 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr
->min
)
1982 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr
->max
))
1985 if (range_int_cst_singleton_p (vr
))
1987 *may_be_nonzero
= tree_to_double_int (vr
->min
);
1988 *must_be_nonzero
= *may_be_nonzero
;
1990 else if (tree_int_cst_sgn (vr
->min
) >= 0
1991 || tree_int_cst_sgn (vr
->max
) < 0)
1993 double_int dmin
= tree_to_double_int (vr
->min
);
1994 double_int dmax
= tree_to_double_int (vr
->max
);
1995 double_int xor_mask
= dmin
^ dmax
;
1996 *may_be_nonzero
= dmin
| dmax
;
1997 *must_be_nonzero
= dmin
& dmax
;
1998 if (xor_mask
.high
!= 0)
2000 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
2001 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) 1
2002 << floor_log2 (xor_mask
.high
)) - 1;
2003 may_be_nonzero
->low
= ALL_ONES
;
2004 may_be_nonzero
->high
|= mask
;
2005 must_be_nonzero
->low
= 0;
2006 must_be_nonzero
->high
&= ~mask
;
2008 else if (xor_mask
.low
!= 0)
2010 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
2011 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) 1
2012 << floor_log2 (xor_mask
.low
)) - 1;
2013 may_be_nonzero
->low
|= mask
;
2014 must_be_nonzero
->low
&= ~mask
;
2021 /* Create two value-ranges in *VR0 and *VR1 from the anti-range *AR
2022 so that *VR0 U *VR1 == *AR. Returns true if that is possible,
2023 false otherwise. If *AR can be represented with a single range
2024 *VR1 will be VR_UNDEFINED. */
2027 ranges_from_anti_range (value_range_t
*ar
,
2028 value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
2030 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (ar
->min
);
2032 vr0
->type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
2033 vr1
->type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
2035 if (ar
->type
!= VR_ANTI_RANGE
2036 || TREE_CODE (ar
->min
) != INTEGER_CST
2037 || TREE_CODE (ar
->max
) != INTEGER_CST
2038 || !vrp_val_min (type
)
2039 || !vrp_val_max (type
))
2042 if (!vrp_val_is_min (ar
->min
))
2044 vr0
->type
= VR_RANGE
;
2045 vr0
->min
= vrp_val_min (type
);
2047 = double_int_to_tree (type
,
2048 tree_to_double_int (ar
->min
) - double_int_one
);
2050 if (!vrp_val_is_max (ar
->max
))
2052 vr1
->type
= VR_RANGE
;
2054 = double_int_to_tree (type
,
2055 tree_to_double_int (ar
->max
) + double_int_one
);
2056 vr1
->max
= vrp_val_max (type
);
2058 if (vr0
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
2061 vr1
->type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
2064 return vr0
->type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
;
2067 /* Helper to extract a value-range *VR for a multiplicative operation
2071 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (value_range_t
*vr
,
2072 enum tree_code code
,
2073 value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
2075 enum value_range_type type
;
2082 /* Multiplications, divisions and shifts are a bit tricky to handle,
2083 depending on the mix of signs we have in the two ranges, we
2084 need to operate on different values to get the minimum and
2085 maximum values for the new range. One approach is to figure
2086 out all the variations of range combinations and do the
2089 However, this involves several calls to compare_values and it
2090 is pretty convoluted. It's simpler to do the 4 operations
2091 (MIN0 OP MIN1, MIN0 OP MAX1, MAX0 OP MIN1 and MAX0 OP MAX0 OP
2092 MAX1) and then figure the smallest and largest values to form
2094 gcc_assert (code
== MULT_EXPR
2095 || code
== TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2096 || code
== FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2097 || code
== CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2098 || code
== EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2099 || code
== ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2100 || code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
2101 || code
== LSHIFT_EXPR
);
2102 gcc_assert ((vr0
->type
== VR_RANGE
2103 || (code
== MULT_EXPR
&& vr0
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
))
2104 && vr0
->type
== vr1
->type
);
2108 /* Compute the 4 cross operations. */
2110 val
[0] = vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
->min
, vr1
->min
);
2111 if (val
[0] == NULL_TREE
)
2114 if (vr1
->max
== vr1
->min
)
2118 val
[1] = vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
->min
, vr1
->max
);
2119 if (val
[1] == NULL_TREE
)
2123 if (vr0
->max
== vr0
->min
)
2127 val
[2] = vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
->max
, vr1
->min
);
2128 if (val
[2] == NULL_TREE
)
2132 if (vr0
->min
== vr0
->max
|| vr1
->min
== vr1
->max
)
2136 val
[3] = vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
->max
, vr1
->max
);
2137 if (val
[3] == NULL_TREE
)
2143 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2147 /* Set MIN to the minimum of VAL[i] and MAX to the maximum
2151 for (i
= 1; i
< 4; i
++)
2153 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (min
)
2154 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min
) && !is_overflow_infinity (min
))
2155 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max
)
2156 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max
) && !is_overflow_infinity (max
)))
2161 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val
[i
])
2162 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (val
[i
])
2163 && !is_overflow_infinity (val
[i
])))
2165 /* If we found an overflowed value, set MIN and MAX
2166 to it so that we set the resulting range to
2172 if (compare_values (val
[i
], min
) == -1)
2175 if (compare_values (val
[i
], max
) == 1)
2180 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
2181 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity
2183 if (min
== NULL_TREE
2184 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (min
)
2185 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min
) && !is_overflow_infinity (min
))
2187 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max
)
2188 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max
) && !is_overflow_infinity (max
)))
2190 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2196 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
2197 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
2198 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
2199 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
2200 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
2202 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min
) || is_overflow_infinity (min
))
2203 && (vrp_val_is_max (max
) || is_overflow_infinity (max
)))
2205 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2209 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
2210 if (cmp
== -2 || cmp
== 1)
2212 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
2213 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
2214 the new range VARYING. */
2215 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2218 set_value_range (vr
, type
, min
, max
, NULL
);
2221 /* Some quadruple precision helpers. */
2223 quad_int_cmp (double_int l0
, double_int h0
,
2224 double_int l1
, double_int h1
, bool uns
)
2226 int c
= h0
.cmp (h1
, uns
);
2227 if (c
!= 0) return c
;
2228 return l0
.ucmp (l1
);
2232 quad_int_pair_sort (double_int
*l0
, double_int
*h0
,
2233 double_int
*l1
, double_int
*h1
, bool uns
)
2235 if (quad_int_cmp (*l0
, *h0
, *l1
, *h1
, uns
) > 0)
2238 tmp
= *l0
; *l0
= *l1
; *l1
= tmp
;
2239 tmp
= *h0
; *h0
= *h1
; *h1
= tmp
;
2243 /* Extract range information from a binary operation CODE based on
2244 the ranges of each of its operands, *VR0 and *VR1 with resulting
2245 type EXPR_TYPE. The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
2248 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (value_range_t
*vr
,
2249 enum tree_code code
, tree expr_type
,
2250 value_range_t
*vr0_
, value_range_t
*vr1_
)
2252 value_range_t vr0
= *vr0_
, vr1
= *vr1_
;
2253 value_range_t vrtem0
= VR_INITIALIZER
, vrtem1
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
2254 enum value_range_type type
;
2255 tree min
= NULL_TREE
, max
= NULL_TREE
;
2258 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (expr_type
)
2259 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type
))
2261 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2265 /* Not all binary expressions can be applied to ranges in a
2266 meaningful way. Handle only arithmetic operations. */
2267 if (code
!= PLUS_EXPR
2268 && code
!= MINUS_EXPR
2269 && code
!= POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
2270 && code
!= MULT_EXPR
2271 && code
!= TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2272 && code
!= FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2273 && code
!= CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2274 && code
!= EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2275 && code
!= ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2276 && code
!= TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2277 && code
!= RSHIFT_EXPR
2278 && code
!= LSHIFT_EXPR
2281 && code
!= BIT_AND_EXPR
2282 && code
!= BIT_IOR_EXPR
2283 && code
!= BIT_XOR_EXPR
)
2285 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2289 /* If both ranges are UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
2290 if (vr0
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
&& vr1
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
2292 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr
);
2295 /* If one of the ranges is UNDEFINED drop it to VARYING for the following
2296 code. At some point we may want to special-case operations that
2297 have UNDEFINED result for all or some value-ranges of the not UNDEFINED
2299 else if (vr0
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
2300 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0
);
2301 else if (vr1
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
2302 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1
);
2304 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
2305 and express ~[] op X as ([]' op X) U ([]'' op X). */
2306 if (vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
2307 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0
, &vrtem0
, &vrtem1
))
2309 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, code
, expr_type
, &vrtem0
, vr1_
);
2310 if (vrtem1
.type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
)
2312 value_range_t vrres
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
2313 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres
, code
, expr_type
,
2315 vrp_meet (vr
, &vrres
);
2319 /* Likewise for X op ~[]. */
2320 if (vr1
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
2321 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr1
, &vrtem0
, &vrtem1
))
2323 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, code
, expr_type
, vr0_
, &vrtem0
);
2324 if (vrtem1
.type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
)
2326 value_range_t vrres
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
2327 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres
, code
, expr_type
,
2329 vrp_meet (vr
, &vrres
);
2334 /* The type of the resulting value range defaults to VR0.TYPE. */
2337 /* Refuse to operate on VARYING ranges, ranges of different kinds
2338 and symbolic ranges. As an exception, we allow BIT_AND_EXPR
2339 because we may be able to derive a useful range even if one of
2340 the operands is VR_VARYING or symbolic range. Similarly for
2341 divisions. TODO, we may be able to derive anti-ranges in
2343 if (code
!= BIT_AND_EXPR
2344 && code
!= BIT_IOR_EXPR
2345 && code
!= TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2346 && code
!= FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2347 && code
!= CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2348 && code
!= EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2349 && code
!= ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2350 && code
!= TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2353 && (vr0
.type
== VR_VARYING
2354 || vr1
.type
== VR_VARYING
2355 || vr0
.type
!= vr1
.type
2356 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0
)
2357 || symbolic_range_p (&vr1
)))
2359 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2363 /* Now evaluate the expression to determine the new range. */
2364 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type
))
2366 if (code
== MIN_EXPR
|| code
== MAX_EXPR
)
2368 /* For MIN/MAX expressions with pointers, we only care about
2369 nullness, if both are non null, then the result is nonnull.
2370 If both are null, then the result is null. Otherwise they
2372 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0
) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1
))
2373 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, expr_type
);
2374 else if (range_is_null (&vr0
) && range_is_null (&vr1
))
2375 set_value_range_to_null (vr
, expr_type
);
2377 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2379 else if (code
== POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
)
2381 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2382 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2383 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0
) || range_is_nonnull (&vr1
))
2384 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, expr_type
);
2385 else if (range_is_null (&vr0
) && range_is_null (&vr1
))
2386 set_value_range_to_null (vr
, expr_type
);
2388 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2390 else if (code
== BIT_AND_EXPR
)
2392 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2393 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2394 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0
) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1
))
2395 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, expr_type
);
2396 else if (range_is_null (&vr0
) || range_is_null (&vr1
))
2397 set_value_range_to_null (vr
, expr_type
);
2399 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2402 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2407 /* For integer ranges, apply the operation to each end of the
2408 range and see what we end up with. */
2409 if (code
== PLUS_EXPR
|| code
== MINUS_EXPR
)
2411 /* If we have a PLUS_EXPR with two VR_RANGE integer constant
2412 ranges compute the precise range for such case if possible. */
2413 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr0
)
2414 && range_int_cst_p (&vr1
)
2415 /* We need as many bits as the possibly unsigned inputs. */
2416 && TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
) <= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
)
2418 double_int min0
= tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
);
2419 double_int max0
= tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
);
2420 double_int min1
= tree_to_double_int (vr1
.min
);
2421 double_int max1
= tree_to_double_int (vr1
.max
);
2422 bool uns
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
);
2424 = double_int::min_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
), uns
);
2426 = double_int::max_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
), uns
);
2427 double_int dmin
, dmax
;
2431 if (code
== PLUS_EXPR
)
2436 /* Check for overflow in double_int. */
2437 if (min1
.cmp (double_int_zero
, uns
) != dmin
.cmp (min0
, uns
))
2438 min_ovf
= min0
.cmp (dmin
, uns
);
2439 if (max1
.cmp (double_int_zero
, uns
) != dmax
.cmp (max0
, uns
))
2440 max_ovf
= max0
.cmp (dmax
, uns
);
2442 else /* if (code == MINUS_EXPR) */
2447 if (double_int_zero
.cmp (max1
, uns
) != dmin
.cmp (min0
, uns
))
2448 min_ovf
= min0
.cmp (max1
, uns
);
2449 if (double_int_zero
.cmp (min1
, uns
) != dmax
.cmp (max0
, uns
))
2450 max_ovf
= max0
.cmp (min1
, uns
);
2453 /* For non-wrapping arithmetic look at possibly smaller
2454 value-ranges of the type. */
2455 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type
))
2457 if (vrp_val_min (expr_type
))
2458 type_min
= tree_to_double_int (vrp_val_min (expr_type
));
2459 if (vrp_val_max (expr_type
))
2460 type_max
= tree_to_double_int (vrp_val_max (expr_type
));
2463 /* Check for type overflow. */
2466 if (dmin
.cmp (type_min
, uns
) == -1)
2468 else if (dmin
.cmp (type_max
, uns
) == 1)
2473 if (dmax
.cmp (type_min
, uns
) == -1)
2475 else if (dmax
.cmp (type_max
, uns
) == 1)
2479 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type
))
2481 /* If overflow wraps, truncate the values and adjust the
2482 range kind and bounds appropriately. */
2484 = dmin
.ext (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
), uns
);
2486 = dmax
.ext (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
), uns
);
2487 if (min_ovf
== max_ovf
)
2489 /* No overflow or both overflow or underflow. The
2490 range kind stays VR_RANGE. */
2491 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, tmin
);
2492 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, tmax
);
2494 else if (min_ovf
== -1
2497 /* Underflow and overflow, drop to VR_VARYING. */
2498 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2503 /* Min underflow or max overflow. The range kind
2504 changes to VR_ANTI_RANGE. */
2505 bool covers
= false;
2506 double_int tem
= tmin
;
2507 gcc_assert ((min_ovf
== -1 && max_ovf
== 0)
2508 || (max_ovf
== 1 && min_ovf
== 0));
2509 type
= VR_ANTI_RANGE
;
2510 tmin
= tmax
+ double_int_one
;
2511 if (tmin
.cmp (tmax
, uns
) < 0)
2513 tmax
= tem
+ double_int_minus_one
;
2514 if (tmax
.cmp (tem
, uns
) > 0)
2516 /* If the anti-range would cover nothing, drop to varying.
2517 Likewise if the anti-range bounds are outside of the
2519 if (covers
|| tmin
.cmp (tmax
, uns
) > 0)
2521 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2524 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, tmin
);
2525 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, tmax
);
2530 /* If overflow does not wrap, saturate to the types min/max
2534 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type
)
2535 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type
))
2536 min
= negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2538 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, type_min
);
2540 else if (min_ovf
== 1)
2542 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type
)
2543 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type
))
2544 min
= positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2546 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, type_max
);
2549 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, dmin
);
2553 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type
)
2554 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type
))
2555 max
= negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2557 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, type_min
);
2559 else if (max_ovf
== 1)
2561 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type
)
2562 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type
))
2563 max
= positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2565 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, type_max
);
2568 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, dmax
);
2570 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type
)
2571 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type
))
2573 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr0
.min
)
2574 || (code
== PLUS_EXPR
2575 ? is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr1
.min
)
2576 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr1
.max
)))
2577 min
= negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2578 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr0
.max
)
2579 || (code
== PLUS_EXPR
2580 ? is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr1
.max
)
2581 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr1
.min
)))
2582 max
= positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type
);
2587 /* For other cases, for example if we have a PLUS_EXPR with two
2588 VR_ANTI_RANGEs, drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort
2589 to compute a precise range for such a case.
2590 ??? General even mixed range kind operations can be expressed
2591 by for example transforming ~[3, 5] + [1, 2] to range-only
2592 operations and a union primitive:
2593 [-INF, 2] + [1, 2] U [5, +INF] + [1, 2]
2594 [-INF+1, 4] U [6, +INF(OVF)]
2595 though usually the union is not exactly representable with
2596 a single range or anti-range as the above is
2597 [-INF+1, +INF(OVF)] intersected with ~[5, 5]
2598 but one could use a scheme similar to equivalences for this. */
2599 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2603 else if (code
== MIN_EXPR
2604 || code
== MAX_EXPR
)
2606 if (vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
2607 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr0
))
2610 if (vr1
.type
== VR_RANGE
2611 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1
))
2613 /* For operations that make the resulting range directly
2614 proportional to the original ranges, apply the operation to
2615 the same end of each range. */
2616 min
= vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
.min
, vr1
.min
);
2617 max
= vrp_int_const_binop (code
, vr0
.max
, vr1
.max
);
2619 else if (code
== MIN_EXPR
)
2621 min
= vrp_val_min (expr_type
);
2624 else if (code
== MAX_EXPR
)
2627 max
= vrp_val_max (expr_type
);
2630 else if (vr1
.type
== VR_RANGE
2631 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1
))
2634 if (code
== MIN_EXPR
)
2636 min
= vrp_val_min (expr_type
);
2639 else if (code
== MAX_EXPR
)
2642 max
= vrp_val_max (expr_type
);
2647 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2651 else if (code
== MULT_EXPR
)
2653 /* Fancy code so that with unsigned, [-3,-1]*[-3,-1] does not
2655 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr0
)
2656 && range_int_cst_p (&vr1
)
2657 && TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type
))
2659 double_int min0
, max0
, min1
, max1
, sizem1
, size
;
2660 double_int prod0l
, prod0h
, prod1l
, prod1h
,
2661 prod2l
, prod2h
, prod3l
, prod3h
;
2662 bool uns0
, uns1
, uns
;
2664 sizem1
= double_int::max_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
), true);
2665 size
= sizem1
+ double_int_one
;
2667 min0
= tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
);
2668 max0
= tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
);
2669 min1
= tree_to_double_int (vr1
.min
);
2670 max1
= tree_to_double_int (vr1
.max
);
2672 uns0
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
);
2675 /* Canonicalize the intervals. */
2676 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
))
2678 double_int min2
= size
- min0
;
2679 if (!min2
.is_zero () && min2
.cmp (max0
, true) < 0)
2687 if (!min2
.is_zero () && min2
.cmp (max1
, true) < 0)
2697 prod0l
= min0
.wide_mul_with_sign (min1
, true, &prod0h
, &overflow
);
2698 if (!uns0
&& min0
.is_negative ())
2700 if (!uns1
&& min1
.is_negative ())
2703 prod1l
= min0
.wide_mul_with_sign (max1
, true, &prod1h
, &overflow
);
2704 if (!uns0
&& min0
.is_negative ())
2706 if (!uns1
&& max1
.is_negative ())
2709 prod2l
= max0
.wide_mul_with_sign (min1
, true, &prod2h
, &overflow
);
2710 if (!uns0
&& max0
.is_negative ())
2712 if (!uns1
&& min1
.is_negative ())
2715 prod3l
= max0
.wide_mul_with_sign (max1
, true, &prod3h
, &overflow
);
2716 if (!uns0
&& max0
.is_negative ())
2718 if (!uns1
&& max1
.is_negative ())
2721 /* Sort the 4 products. */
2722 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod0l
, &prod0h
, &prod3l
, &prod3h
, uns
);
2723 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod1l
, &prod1h
, &prod2l
, &prod2h
, uns
);
2724 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod0l
, &prod0h
, &prod1l
, &prod1h
, uns
);
2725 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod2l
, &prod2h
, &prod3l
, &prod3h
, uns
);
2728 if (prod0l
.is_zero ())
2730 prod1l
= double_int_zero
;
2738 prod2l
= prod3l
+ prod1l
;
2739 prod2h
= prod3h
+ prod1h
;
2740 if (prod2l
.ult (prod3l
))
2741 prod2h
+= double_int_one
; /* carry */
2743 if (!prod2h
.is_zero ()
2744 || prod2l
.cmp (sizem1
, true) >= 0)
2746 /* the range covers all values. */
2747 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2751 /* The following should handle the wrapping and selecting
2752 VR_ANTI_RANGE for us. */
2753 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, prod0l
);
2754 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, prod3l
);
2755 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, NULL
);
2759 /* If we have an unsigned MULT_EXPR with two VR_ANTI_RANGEs,
2760 drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort to compute a
2761 precise range for such a case. For example, if we have
2762 op0 == 65536 and op1 == 65536 with their ranges both being
2763 ~[0,0] on a 32-bit machine, we would have op0 * op1 == 0, so
2764 we cannot claim that the product is in ~[0,0]. Note that we
2765 are guaranteed to have vr0.type == vr1.type at this
2767 if (vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
2768 && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (expr_type
))
2770 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2774 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr
, code
, &vr0
, &vr1
);
2777 else if (code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
2778 || code
== LSHIFT_EXPR
)
2780 /* If we have a RSHIFT_EXPR with any shift values outside [0..prec-1],
2781 then drop to VR_VARYING. Outside of this range we get undefined
2782 behavior from the shift operation. We cannot even trust
2783 SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED at this stage, because that applies to rtl
2784 shifts, and the operation at the tree level may be widened. */
2785 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr1
)
2786 && compare_tree_int (vr1
.min
, 0) >= 0
2787 && compare_tree_int (vr1
.max
, TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
)) == -1)
2789 if (code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
)
2791 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr
, code
, &vr0
, &vr1
);
2794 /* We can map lshifts by constants to MULT_EXPR handling. */
2795 else if (code
== LSHIFT_EXPR
2796 && range_int_cst_singleton_p (&vr1
))
2798 bool saved_flag_wrapv
;
2799 value_range_t vr1p
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
2800 vr1p
.type
= VR_RANGE
;
2802 = double_int_to_tree (expr_type
,
2804 .llshift (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (vr1
.min
),
2805 TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
)));
2806 vr1p
.max
= vr1p
.min
;
2807 /* We have to use a wrapping multiply though as signed overflow
2808 on lshifts is implementation defined in C89. */
2809 saved_flag_wrapv
= flag_wrapv
;
2811 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, MULT_EXPR
, expr_type
,
2813 flag_wrapv
= saved_flag_wrapv
;
2816 else if (code
== LSHIFT_EXPR
2817 && range_int_cst_p (&vr0
))
2819 int prec
= TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type
);
2820 int overflow_pos
= prec
;
2822 double_int bound
, complement
, low_bound
, high_bound
;
2823 bool uns
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
);
2824 bool in_bounds
= false;
2829 bound_shift
= overflow_pos
- TREE_INT_CST_LOW (vr1
.max
);
2830 /* If bound_shift == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, the llshift can
2831 overflow. However, for that to happen, vr1.max needs to be
2832 zero, which means vr1 is a singleton range of zero, which
2833 means it should be handled by the previous LSHIFT_EXPR
2835 bound
= double_int_one
.llshift (bound_shift
, prec
);
2836 complement
= ~(bound
- double_int_one
);
2841 high_bound
= complement
.zext (prec
);
2842 if (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
).ult (low_bound
))
2844 /* [5, 6] << [1, 2] == [10, 24]. */
2845 /* We're shifting out only zeroes, the value increases
2849 else if (high_bound
.ult (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
)))
2851 /* [0xffffff00, 0xffffffff] << [1, 2]
2852 == [0xfffffc00, 0xfffffffe]. */
2853 /* We're shifting out only ones, the value decreases
2860 /* [-1, 1] << [1, 2] == [-4, 4]. */
2861 low_bound
= complement
.sext (prec
);
2863 if (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
).slt (high_bound
)
2864 && low_bound
.slt (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
)))
2866 /* For non-negative numbers, we're shifting out only
2867 zeroes, the value increases monotonically.
2868 For negative numbers, we're shifting out only ones, the
2869 value decreases monotomically. */
2876 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr
, code
, &vr0
, &vr1
);
2881 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2884 else if (code
== TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2885 || code
== FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2886 || code
== CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2887 || code
== EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2888 || code
== ROUND_DIV_EXPR
)
2890 if (vr0
.type
!= VR_RANGE
|| symbolic_range_p (&vr0
))
2892 /* For division, if op1 has VR_RANGE but op0 does not, something
2893 can be deduced just from that range. Say [min, max] / [4, max]
2894 gives [min / 4, max / 4] range. */
2895 if (vr1
.type
== VR_RANGE
2896 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1
)
2897 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1
.min
, vr1
.max
) == 0)
2899 vr0
.type
= type
= VR_RANGE
;
2900 vr0
.min
= vrp_val_min (expr_type
);
2901 vr0
.max
= vrp_val_max (expr_type
);
2905 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2910 /* For divisions, if flag_non_call_exceptions is true, we must
2911 not eliminate a division by zero. */
2912 if (cfun
->can_throw_non_call_exceptions
2913 && (vr1
.type
!= VR_RANGE
2914 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1
.min
, vr1
.max
) != 0))
2916 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2920 /* For divisions, if op0 is VR_RANGE, we can deduce a range
2921 even if op1 is VR_VARYING, VR_ANTI_RANGE, symbolic or can
2923 if (vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
2924 && (vr1
.type
!= VR_RANGE
2925 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1
.min
, vr1
.max
) != 0))
2927 tree zero
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr0
.min
), 0);
2932 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
)
2933 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr1
))
2935 /* For unsigned division or when divisor is known
2936 to be non-negative, the range has to cover
2937 all numbers from 0 to max for positive max
2938 and all numbers from min to 0 for negative min. */
2939 cmp
= compare_values (vr0
.max
, zero
);
2942 else if (cmp
== 0 || cmp
== 1)
2946 cmp
= compare_values (vr0
.min
, zero
);
2949 else if (cmp
== 0 || cmp
== -1)
2956 /* Otherwise the range is -max .. max or min .. -min
2957 depending on which bound is bigger in absolute value,
2958 as the division can change the sign. */
2959 abs_extent_range (vr
, vr0
.min
, vr0
.max
);
2962 if (type
== VR_VARYING
)
2964 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2970 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr
, code
, &vr0
, &vr1
);
2974 else if (code
== TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
)
2976 if (vr1
.type
!= VR_RANGE
2977 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1
.min
, vr1
.max
) != 0
2978 || vrp_val_is_min (vr1
.min
))
2980 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
2984 /* Compute MAX <|vr1.min|, |vr1.max|> - 1. */
2985 max
= fold_unary_to_constant (ABS_EXPR
, expr_type
, vr1
.min
);
2986 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max
, vr1
.max
))
2988 max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, max
, integer_one_node
);
2989 /* If the dividend is non-negative the modulus will be
2990 non-negative as well. */
2991 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
)
2992 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr0
))
2993 min
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max
), 0);
2995 min
= fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR
, expr_type
, max
);
2997 else if (code
== BIT_AND_EXPR
|| code
== BIT_IOR_EXPR
|| code
== BIT_XOR_EXPR
)
2999 bool int_cst_range0
, int_cst_range1
;
3000 double_int may_be_nonzero0
, may_be_nonzero1
;
3001 double_int must_be_nonzero0
, must_be_nonzero1
;
3003 int_cst_range0
= zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr0
, &may_be_nonzero0
,
3005 int_cst_range1
= zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr1
, &may_be_nonzero1
,
3009 if (code
== BIT_AND_EXPR
)
3012 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
,
3013 must_be_nonzero0
& must_be_nonzero1
);
3014 dmax
= may_be_nonzero0
& may_be_nonzero1
;
3015 /* If both input ranges contain only negative values we can
3016 truncate the result range maximum to the minimum of the
3017 input range maxima. */
3018 if (int_cst_range0
&& int_cst_range1
3019 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0
.max
) < 0
3020 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1
.max
) < 0)
3022 dmax
= dmax
.min (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
),
3023 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3024 dmax
= dmax
.min (tree_to_double_int (vr1
.max
),
3025 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3027 /* If either input range contains only non-negative values
3028 we can truncate the result range maximum to the respective
3029 maximum of the input range. */
3030 if (int_cst_range0
&& tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0
.min
) >= 0)
3031 dmax
= dmax
.min (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
),
3032 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3033 if (int_cst_range1
&& tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1
.min
) >= 0)
3034 dmax
= dmax
.min (tree_to_double_int (vr1
.max
),
3035 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3036 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, dmax
);
3038 else if (code
== BIT_IOR_EXPR
)
3041 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
,
3042 may_be_nonzero0
| may_be_nonzero1
);
3043 dmin
= must_be_nonzero0
| must_be_nonzero1
;
3044 /* If the input ranges contain only positive values we can
3045 truncate the minimum of the result range to the maximum
3046 of the input range minima. */
3047 if (int_cst_range0
&& int_cst_range1
3048 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0
.min
) >= 0
3049 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1
.min
) >= 0)
3051 dmin
= dmin
.max (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
),
3052 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3053 dmin
= dmin
.max (tree_to_double_int (vr1
.min
),
3054 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3056 /* If either input range contains only negative values
3057 we can truncate the minimum of the result range to the
3058 respective minimum range. */
3059 if (int_cst_range0
&& tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0
.max
) < 0)
3060 dmin
= dmin
.max (tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
),
3061 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3062 if (int_cst_range1
&& tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1
.max
) < 0)
3063 dmin
= dmin
.max (tree_to_double_int (vr1
.min
),
3064 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type
));
3065 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, dmin
);
3067 else if (code
== BIT_XOR_EXPR
)
3069 double_int result_zero_bits
, result_one_bits
;
3070 result_zero_bits
= (must_be_nonzero0
& must_be_nonzero1
)
3071 | ~(may_be_nonzero0
| may_be_nonzero1
);
3072 result_one_bits
= must_be_nonzero0
.and_not (may_be_nonzero1
)
3073 | must_be_nonzero1
.and_not (may_be_nonzero0
);
3074 max
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, ~result_zero_bits
);
3075 min
= double_int_to_tree (expr_type
, result_one_bits
);
3076 /* If the range has all positive or all negative values the
3077 result is better than VARYING. */
3078 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (min
) < 0
3079 || tree_int_cst_sgn (max
) >= 0)
3082 max
= min
= NULL_TREE
;
3088 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
3089 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity
3091 if (min
== NULL_TREE
3092 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (min
)
3093 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min
) && !is_overflow_infinity (min
))
3095 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max
)
3096 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max
) && !is_overflow_infinity (max
)))
3098 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3104 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
3105 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
3106 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
3107 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
3108 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
3110 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min
) || is_overflow_infinity (min
))
3111 && (vrp_val_is_max (max
) || is_overflow_infinity (max
)))
3113 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3117 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
3118 if (cmp
== -2 || cmp
== 1)
3120 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3121 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3122 the new range VARYING. */
3123 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3126 set_value_range (vr
, type
, min
, max
, NULL
);
3129 /* Extract range information from a binary expression OP0 CODE OP1 based on
3130 the ranges of each of its operands with resulting type EXPR_TYPE.
3131 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3134 extract_range_from_binary_expr (value_range_t
*vr
,
3135 enum tree_code code
,
3136 tree expr_type
, tree op0
, tree op1
)
3138 value_range_t vr0
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3139 value_range_t vr1
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3141 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3142 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3143 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
3144 vr0
= *(get_value_range (op0
));
3145 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0
))
3146 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0
, op0
, NULL
);
3148 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0
);
3150 if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
3151 vr1
= *(get_value_range (op1
));
3152 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1
))
3153 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1
, op1
, NULL
);
3155 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1
);
3157 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, code
, expr_type
, &vr0
, &vr1
);
3160 /* Extract range information from a unary operation CODE based on
3161 the range of its operand *VR0 with type OP0_TYPE with resulting type TYPE.
3162 The The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3165 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (value_range_t
*vr
,
3166 enum tree_code code
, tree type
,
3167 value_range_t
*vr0_
, tree op0_type
)
3169 value_range_t vr0
= *vr0_
, vrtem0
= VR_INITIALIZER
, vrtem1
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3171 /* VRP only operates on integral and pointer types. */
3172 if (!(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (op0_type
)
3173 || POINTER_TYPE_P (op0_type
))
3174 || !(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
3175 || POINTER_TYPE_P (type
)))
3177 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3181 /* If VR0 is UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
3182 if (vr0
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
3184 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr
);
3188 /* Handle operations that we express in terms of others. */
3189 if (code
== PAREN_EXPR
)
3191 /* PAREN_EXPR is a simple copy. */
3192 copy_value_range (vr
, &vr0
);
3195 else if (code
== NEGATE_EXPR
)
3197 /* -X is simply 0 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3198 anti-ranges fine. */
3199 value_range_t zero
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3200 set_value_range_to_value (&zero
, build_int_cst (type
, 0), NULL
);
3201 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, MINUS_EXPR
, type
, &zero
, &vr0
);
3204 else if (code
== BIT_NOT_EXPR
)
3206 /* ~X is simply -1 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3207 anti-ranges fine. */
3208 value_range_t minusone
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3209 set_value_range_to_value (&minusone
, build_int_cst (type
, -1), NULL
);
3210 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr
, MINUS_EXPR
,
3211 type
, &minusone
, &vr0
);
3215 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
3216 and express op ~[] as (op []') U (op []''). */
3217 if (vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
3218 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0
, &vrtem0
, &vrtem1
))
3220 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (vr
, code
, type
, &vrtem0
, op0_type
);
3221 if (vrtem1
.type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
)
3223 value_range_t vrres
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3224 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (&vrres
, code
, type
,
3226 vrp_meet (vr
, &vrres
);
3231 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code
))
3233 tree inner_type
= op0_type
;
3234 tree outer_type
= type
;
3236 /* If the expression evaluates to a pointer, we are only interested in
3237 determining if it evaluates to NULL [0, 0] or non-NULL (~[0, 0]). */
3238 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type
))
3240 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0
))
3241 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, type
);
3242 else if (range_is_null (&vr0
))
3243 set_value_range_to_null (vr
, type
);
3245 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3249 /* If VR0 is varying and we increase the type precision, assume
3250 a full range for the following transformation. */
3251 if (vr0
.type
== VR_VARYING
3252 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (inner_type
)
3253 && TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type
) < TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type
))
3255 vr0
.type
= VR_RANGE
;
3256 vr0
.min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (inner_type
);
3257 vr0
.max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (inner_type
);
3260 /* If VR0 is a constant range or anti-range and the conversion is
3261 not truncating we can convert the min and max values and
3262 canonicalize the resulting range. Otherwise we can do the
3263 conversion if the size of the range is less than what the
3264 precision of the target type can represent and the range is
3265 not an anti-range. */
3266 if ((vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
3267 || vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
3268 && TREE_CODE (vr0
.min
) == INTEGER_CST
3269 && TREE_CODE (vr0
.max
) == INTEGER_CST
3270 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.min
)
3271 || (vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
3272 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type
) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type
)
3273 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type
)
3274 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type
)))
3275 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.max
)
3276 || (vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
3277 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type
) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type
)
3278 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type
)
3279 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type
)))
3280 && (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type
) >= TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type
)
3281 || (vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
3282 && integer_zerop (int_const_binop (RSHIFT_EXPR
,
3283 int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, vr0
.max
, vr0
.min
),
3284 size_int (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type
)))))))
3286 tree new_min
, new_max
;
3287 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.min
))
3288 new_min
= negative_overflow_infinity (outer_type
);
3290 new_min
= force_fit_type_double (outer_type
,
3291 tree_to_double_int (vr0
.min
),
3293 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.max
))
3294 new_max
= positive_overflow_infinity (outer_type
);
3296 new_max
= force_fit_type_double (outer_type
,
3297 tree_to_double_int (vr0
.max
),
3299 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr
, vr0
.type
,
3300 new_min
, new_max
, NULL
);
3304 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3307 else if (code
== ABS_EXPR
)
3312 /* Pass through vr0 in the easy cases. */
3313 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
)
3314 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr0
))
3316 copy_value_range (vr
, &vr0
);
3320 /* For the remaining varying or symbolic ranges we can't do anything
3322 if (vr0
.type
== VR_VARYING
3323 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0
))
3325 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3329 /* -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE with flag_wrapv so we can't get a
3331 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (type
)
3332 && ((vr0
.type
== VR_RANGE
3333 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0
.min
))
3334 || (vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
3335 && !vrp_val_is_min (vr0
.min
))))
3337 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3341 /* ABS_EXPR may flip the range around, if the original range
3342 included negative values. */
3343 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.min
))
3344 min
= positive_overflow_infinity (type
);
3345 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0
.min
))
3346 min
= fold_unary_to_constant (code
, type
, vr0
.min
);
3347 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type
))
3348 min
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
3349 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type
))
3350 min
= positive_overflow_infinity (type
);
3353 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3357 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0
.max
))
3358 max
= positive_overflow_infinity (type
);
3359 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0
.max
))
3360 max
= fold_unary_to_constant (code
, type
, vr0
.max
);
3361 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type
))
3362 max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
3363 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type
)
3364 /* We shouldn't generate [+INF, +INF] as set_value_range
3365 doesn't like this and ICEs. */
3366 && !is_positive_overflow_infinity (min
))
3367 max
= positive_overflow_infinity (type
);
3370 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3374 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
3376 /* If a VR_ANTI_RANGEs contains zero, then we have
3377 ~[-INF, min(MIN, MAX)]. */
3378 if (vr0
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
3380 if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0
.min
, vr0
.max
) == 1)
3382 /* Take the lower of the two values. */
3386 /* Create ~[-INF, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))]
3387 or ~[-INF + 1, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))] when
3388 flag_wrapv is set and the original anti-range doesn't include
3389 TYPE_MIN_VALUE, remember -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE. */
3390 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type
))
3392 tree type_min_value
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
);
3394 min
= (vr0
.min
!= type_min_value
3395 ? int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, type_min_value
,
3401 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (&vr0
))
3402 min
= negative_overflow_infinity (type
);
3404 min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
);
3409 /* All else has failed, so create the range [0, INF], even for
3410 flag_wrapv since TYPE_MIN_VALUE is in the original
3412 vr0
.type
= VR_RANGE
;
3413 min
= build_int_cst (type
, 0);
3414 if (needs_overflow_infinity (type
))
3416 if (supports_overflow_infinity (type
))
3417 max
= positive_overflow_infinity (type
);
3420 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3425 max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
3429 /* If the range contains zero then we know that the minimum value in the
3430 range will be zero. */
3431 else if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0
.min
, vr0
.max
) == 1)
3435 min
= build_int_cst (type
, 0);
3439 /* If the range was reversed, swap MIN and MAX. */
3448 cmp
= compare_values (min
, max
);
3449 if (cmp
== -2 || cmp
== 1)
3451 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3452 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3453 the new range VARYING. */
3454 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3457 set_value_range (vr
, vr0
.type
, min
, max
, NULL
);
3461 /* For unhandled operations fall back to varying. */
3462 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3467 /* Extract range information from a unary expression CODE OP0 based on
3468 the range of its operand with resulting type TYPE.
3469 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3472 extract_range_from_unary_expr (value_range_t
*vr
, enum tree_code code
,
3473 tree type
, tree op0
)
3475 value_range_t vr0
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3477 /* Get value ranges for the operand. For constant operands, create
3478 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3479 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
3480 vr0
= *(get_value_range (op0
));
3481 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0
))
3482 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0
, op0
, NULL
);
3484 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0
);
3486 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (vr
, code
, type
, &vr0
, TREE_TYPE (op0
));
3490 /* Extract range information from a conditional expression STMT based on
3491 the ranges of each of its operands and the expression code. */
3494 extract_range_from_cond_expr (value_range_t
*vr
, gimple stmt
)
3497 value_range_t vr0
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3498 value_range_t vr1
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3500 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3501 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3502 op0
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
);
3503 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
3504 vr0
= *(get_value_range (op0
));
3505 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0
))
3506 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0
, op0
, NULL
);
3508 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0
);
3510 op1
= gimple_assign_rhs3 (stmt
);
3511 if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
3512 vr1
= *(get_value_range (op1
));
3513 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1
))
3514 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1
, op1
, NULL
);
3516 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1
);
3518 /* The resulting value range is the union of the operand ranges */
3519 copy_value_range (vr
, &vr0
);
3520 vrp_meet (vr
, &vr1
);
3524 /* Extract range information from a comparison expression EXPR based
3525 on the range of its operand and the expression code. */
3528 extract_range_from_comparison (value_range_t
*vr
, enum tree_code code
,
3529 tree type
, tree op0
, tree op1
)
3534 val
= vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code
, op0
, op1
, false, &sop
,
3537 /* A disadvantage of using a special infinity as an overflow
3538 representation is that we lose the ability to record overflow
3539 when we don't have an infinity. So we have to ignore a result
3540 which relies on overflow. */
3542 if (val
&& !is_overflow_infinity (val
) && !sop
)
3544 /* Since this expression was found on the RHS of an assignment,
3545 its type may be different from _Bool. Convert VAL to EXPR's
3547 val
= fold_convert (type
, val
);
3548 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (val
))
3549 set_value_range_to_value (vr
, val
, vr
->equiv
);
3551 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, val
, val
, vr
->equiv
);
3554 /* The result of a comparison is always true or false. */
3555 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (vr
, type
);
3558 /* Try to derive a nonnegative or nonzero range out of STMT relying
3559 primarily on generic routines in fold in conjunction with range data.
3560 Store the result in *VR */
3563 extract_range_basic (value_range_t
*vr
, gimple stmt
)
3566 tree type
= gimple_expr_type (stmt
);
3568 /* If the call is __builtin_constant_p and the argument is a
3569 function parameter resolve it to false. This avoids bogus
3570 array bound warnings.
3571 ??? We could do this as early as inlining is finished. */
3572 if (gimple_call_builtin_p (stmt
, BUILT_IN_CONSTANT_P
))
3574 tree arg
= gimple_call_arg (stmt
, 0);
3575 if (TREE_CODE (arg
) == SSA_NAME
3576 && SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (arg
)
3577 && TREE_CODE (SSA_NAME_VAR (arg
)) == PARM_DECL
)
3578 set_value_range_to_null (vr
, type
);
3580 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
3581 && gimple_stmt_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt
, &sop
))
3582 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (vr
, type
,
3583 sop
|| stmt_overflow_infinity (stmt
));
3584 else if (vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (stmt
, &sop
)
3586 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr
, type
);
3588 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3592 /* Try to compute a useful range out of assignment STMT and store it
3596 extract_range_from_assignment (value_range_t
*vr
, gimple stmt
)
3598 enum tree_code code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
3600 if (code
== ASSERT_EXPR
)
3601 extract_range_from_assert (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
));
3602 else if (code
== SSA_NAME
)
3603 extract_range_from_ssa_name (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
));
3604 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code
) == tcc_binary
)
3605 extract_range_from_binary_expr (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
3606 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
3607 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
3608 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
));
3609 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code
) == tcc_unary
)
3610 extract_range_from_unary_expr (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
3611 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
3612 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
));
3613 else if (code
== COND_EXPR
)
3614 extract_range_from_cond_expr (vr
, stmt
);
3615 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code
) == tcc_comparison
)
3616 extract_range_from_comparison (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
3617 gimple_expr_type (stmt
),
3618 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
3619 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
));
3620 else if (get_gimple_rhs_class (code
) == GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
3621 && is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
)))
3622 set_value_range_to_value (vr
, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
), NULL
);
3624 set_value_range_to_varying (vr
);
3626 if (vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
3627 extract_range_basic (vr
, stmt
);
3630 /* Given a range VR, a LOOP and a variable VAR, determine whether it
3631 would be profitable to adjust VR using scalar evolution information
3632 for VAR. If so, update VR with the new limits. */
3635 adjust_range_with_scev (value_range_t
*vr
, struct loop
*loop
,
3636 gimple stmt
, tree var
)
3638 tree init
, step
, chrec
, tmin
, tmax
, min
, max
, type
, tem
;
3639 enum ev_direction dir
;
3641 /* TODO. Don't adjust anti-ranges. An anti-range may provide
3642 better opportunities than a regular range, but I'm not sure. */
3643 if (vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
3646 chrec
= instantiate_parameters (loop
, analyze_scalar_evolution (loop
, var
));
3648 /* Like in PR19590, scev can return a constant function. */
3649 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (chrec
))
3651 set_value_range_to_value (vr
, chrec
, vr
->equiv
);
3655 if (TREE_CODE (chrec
) != POLYNOMIAL_CHREC
)
3658 init
= initial_condition_in_loop_num (chrec
, loop
->num
);
3659 tem
= op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (init
);
3662 step
= evolution_part_in_loop_num (chrec
, loop
->num
);
3663 tem
= op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (step
);
3667 /* If STEP is symbolic, we can't know whether INIT will be the
3668 minimum or maximum value in the range. Also, unless INIT is
3669 a simple expression, compare_values and possibly other functions
3670 in tree-vrp won't be able to handle it. */
3671 if (step
== NULL_TREE
3672 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (step
)
3673 || !valid_value_p (init
))
3676 dir
= scev_direction (chrec
);
3677 if (/* Do not adjust ranges if we do not know whether the iv increases
3678 or decreases, ... */
3679 dir
== EV_DIR_UNKNOWN
3680 /* ... or if it may wrap. */
3681 || scev_probably_wraps_p (init
, step
, stmt
, get_chrec_loop (chrec
),
3685 /* We use TYPE_MIN_VALUE and TYPE_MAX_VALUE here instead of
3686 negative_overflow_infinity and positive_overflow_infinity,
3687 because we have concluded that the loop probably does not
3690 type
= TREE_TYPE (var
);
3691 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type
) || !TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
))
3692 tmin
= lower_bound_in_type (type
, type
);
3694 tmin
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
);
3695 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type
) || !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
))
3696 tmax
= upper_bound_in_type (type
, type
);
3698 tmax
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
);
3700 /* Try to use estimated number of iterations for the loop to constrain the
3701 final value in the evolution. */
3702 if (TREE_CODE (step
) == INTEGER_CST
3703 && is_gimple_val (init
)
3704 && (TREE_CODE (init
) != SSA_NAME
3705 || get_value_range (init
)->type
== VR_RANGE
))
3709 /* We are only entering here for loop header PHI nodes, so using
3710 the number of latch executions is the correct thing to use. */
3711 if (max_loop_iterations (loop
, &nit
))
3713 value_range_t maxvr
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
3715 bool unsigned_p
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (step
));
3716 bool overflow
= false;
3718 dtmp
= tree_to_double_int (step
)
3719 .mul_with_sign (nit
, unsigned_p
, &overflow
);
3720 /* If the multiplication overflowed we can't do a meaningful
3721 adjustment. Likewise if the result doesn't fit in the type
3722 of the induction variable. For a signed type we have to
3723 check whether the result has the expected signedness which
3724 is that of the step as number of iterations is unsigned. */
3726 && double_int_fits_to_tree_p (TREE_TYPE (init
), dtmp
)
3728 || ((dtmp
.high
^ TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (step
)) >= 0)))
3730 tem
= double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (init
), dtmp
);
3731 extract_range_from_binary_expr (&maxvr
, PLUS_EXPR
,
3732 TREE_TYPE (init
), init
, tem
);
3733 /* Likewise if the addition did. */
3734 if (maxvr
.type
== VR_RANGE
)
3743 if (vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
|| vr
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
3748 /* For VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges, just about anything we get
3749 from scalar evolutions should be better. */
3751 if (dir
== EV_DIR_DECREASES
)
3756 /* If we would create an invalid range, then just assume we
3757 know absolutely nothing. This may be over-conservative,
3758 but it's clearly safe, and should happen only in unreachable
3759 parts of code, or for invalid programs. */
3760 if (compare_values (min
, max
) == 1)
3763 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, vr
->equiv
);
3765 else if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
)
3770 if (dir
== EV_DIR_DECREASES
)
3772 /* INIT is the maximum value. If INIT is lower than VR->MAX
3773 but no smaller than VR->MIN, set VR->MAX to INIT. */
3774 if (compare_values (init
, max
) == -1)
3777 /* According to the loop information, the variable does not
3778 overflow. If we think it does, probably because of an
3779 overflow due to arithmetic on a different INF value,
3781 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (min
)
3782 || compare_values (min
, tmin
) == -1)
3788 /* If INIT is bigger than VR->MIN, set VR->MIN to INIT. */
3789 if (compare_values (init
, min
) == 1)
3792 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (max
)
3793 || compare_values (tmax
, max
) == -1)
3797 /* If we just created an invalid range with the minimum
3798 greater than the maximum, we fail conservatively.
3799 This should happen only in unreachable
3800 parts of code, or for invalid programs. */
3801 if (compare_values (min
, max
) == 1)
3804 set_value_range (vr
, VR_RANGE
, min
, max
, vr
->equiv
);
3808 /* Return true if VAR may overflow at STMT. This checks any available
3809 loop information to see if we can determine that VAR does not
3813 vrp_var_may_overflow (tree var
, gimple stmt
)
3816 tree chrec
, init
, step
;
3818 if (current_loops
== NULL
)
3821 l
= loop_containing_stmt (stmt
);
3826 chrec
= instantiate_parameters (l
, analyze_scalar_evolution (l
, var
));
3827 if (TREE_CODE (chrec
) != POLYNOMIAL_CHREC
)
3830 init
= initial_condition_in_loop_num (chrec
, l
->num
);
3831 step
= evolution_part_in_loop_num (chrec
, l
->num
);
3833 if (step
== NULL_TREE
3834 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (step
)
3835 || !valid_value_p (init
))
3838 /* If we get here, we know something useful about VAR based on the
3839 loop information. If it wraps, it may overflow. */
3841 if (scev_probably_wraps_p (init
, step
, stmt
, get_chrec_loop (chrec
),
3845 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
) != 0)
3847 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, var
, 0);
3848 fprintf (dump_file
, ": loop information indicates does not overflow\n");
3855 /* Given two numeric value ranges VR0, VR1 and a comparison code COMP:
3857 - Return BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR0 COMP VR1 always returns true for
3858 all the values in the ranges.
3860 - Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison always returns false.
3862 - Return NULL_TREE if it is not always possible to determine the
3863 value of the comparison.
3865 Also set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an
3866 overflow infinity was used in the test. */
3870 compare_ranges (enum tree_code comp
, value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
,
3871 bool *strict_overflow_p
)
3873 /* VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges cannot be compared. */
3874 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
3875 || vr0
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
3876 || vr1
->type
== VR_VARYING
3877 || vr1
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
3880 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
3881 if (vr0
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
|| vr1
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
3883 /* If both are anti-ranges, then we cannot compute any
3885 if (vr0
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
&& vr1
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
3888 /* These comparisons are never statically computable. */
3895 /* Equality can be computed only between a range and an
3896 anti-range. ~[VAL1, VAL2] == [VAL1, VAL2] is always false. */
3897 if (vr0
->type
== VR_RANGE
)
3899 /* To simplify processing, make VR0 the anti-range. */
3900 value_range_t
*tmp
= vr0
;
3905 gcc_assert (comp
== NE_EXPR
|| comp
== EQ_EXPR
);
3907 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->min
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0
3908 && compare_values_warnv (vr0
->max
, vr1
->max
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0)
3909 return (comp
== NE_EXPR
) ? boolean_true_node
: boolean_false_node
;
3914 if (!usable_range_p (vr0
, strict_overflow_p
)
3915 || !usable_range_p (vr1
, strict_overflow_p
))
3918 /* Simplify processing. If COMP is GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR, switch the
3919 operands around and change the comparison code. */
3920 if (comp
== GT_EXPR
|| comp
== GE_EXPR
)
3923 comp
= (comp
== GT_EXPR
) ? LT_EXPR
: LE_EXPR
;
3929 if (comp
== EQ_EXPR
)
3931 /* Equality may only be computed if both ranges represent
3932 exactly one value. */
3933 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr0
->max
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0
3934 && compare_values_warnv (vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0)
3936 int cmp_min
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->min
,
3938 int cmp_max
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->max
, vr1
->max
,
3940 if (cmp_min
== 0 && cmp_max
== 0)
3941 return boolean_true_node
;
3942 else if (cmp_min
!= -2 && cmp_max
!= -2)
3943 return boolean_false_node
;
3945 /* If [V0_MIN, V1_MAX] < [V1_MIN, V1_MAX] then V0 != V1. */
3946 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->max
,
3947 strict_overflow_p
) == 1
3948 || compare_values_warnv (vr1
->min
, vr0
->max
,
3949 strict_overflow_p
) == 1)
3950 return boolean_false_node
;
3954 else if (comp
== NE_EXPR
)
3958 /* If VR0 is completely to the left or completely to the right
3959 of VR1, they are always different. Notice that we need to
3960 make sure that both comparisons yield similar results to
3961 avoid comparing values that cannot be compared at
3963 cmp1
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->max
, vr1
->min
, strict_overflow_p
);
3964 cmp2
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->max
, strict_overflow_p
);
3965 if ((cmp1
== -1 && cmp2
== -1) || (cmp1
== 1 && cmp2
== 1))
3966 return boolean_true_node
;
3968 /* If VR0 and VR1 represent a single value and are identical,
3970 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr0
->max
,
3971 strict_overflow_p
) == 0
3972 && compare_values_warnv (vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
,
3973 strict_overflow_p
) == 0
3974 && compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->min
,
3975 strict_overflow_p
) == 0
3976 && compare_values_warnv (vr0
->max
, vr1
->max
,
3977 strict_overflow_p
) == 0)
3978 return boolean_false_node
;
3980 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
3984 else if (comp
== LT_EXPR
|| comp
== LE_EXPR
)
3988 /* If VR0 is to the left of VR1, return true. */
3989 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->max
, vr1
->min
, strict_overflow_p
);
3990 if ((comp
== LT_EXPR
&& tst
== -1)
3991 || (comp
== LE_EXPR
&& (tst
== -1 || tst
== 0)))
3993 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0
)
3994 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1
))
3995 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
3996 return boolean_true_node
;
3999 /* If VR0 is to the right of VR1, return false. */
4000 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr0
->min
, vr1
->max
, strict_overflow_p
);
4001 if ((comp
== LT_EXPR
&& (tst
== 0 || tst
== 1))
4002 || (comp
== LE_EXPR
&& tst
== 1))
4004 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0
)
4005 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1
))
4006 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
4007 return boolean_false_node
;
4010 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4018 /* Given a value range VR, a value VAL and a comparison code COMP, return
4019 BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR COMP VAL always returns true for all the
4020 values in VR. Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison
4021 always returns false. Return NULL_TREE if it is not always
4022 possible to determine the value of the comparison. Also set
4023 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an overflow
4024 infinity was used in the test. */
4027 compare_range_with_value (enum tree_code comp
, value_range_t
*vr
, tree val
,
4028 bool *strict_overflow_p
)
4030 if (vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
|| vr
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
4033 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
4034 if (vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
4036 /* For anti-ranges, the only predicates that we can compute at
4037 compile time are equality and inequality. */
4044 /* ~[VAL_1, VAL_2] OP VAL is known if VAL_1 <= VAL <= VAL_2. */
4045 if (value_inside_range (val
, vr
->min
, vr
->max
) == 1)
4046 return (comp
== NE_EXPR
) ? boolean_true_node
: boolean_false_node
;
4051 if (!usable_range_p (vr
, strict_overflow_p
))
4054 if (comp
== EQ_EXPR
)
4056 /* EQ_EXPR may only be computed if VR represents exactly
4058 if (compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, vr
->max
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0)
4060 int cmp
= compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, val
, strict_overflow_p
);
4062 return boolean_true_node
;
4063 else if (cmp
== -1 || cmp
== 1 || cmp
== 2)
4064 return boolean_false_node
;
4066 else if (compare_values_warnv (val
, vr
->min
, strict_overflow_p
) == -1
4067 || compare_values_warnv (vr
->max
, val
, strict_overflow_p
) == -1)
4068 return boolean_false_node
;
4072 else if (comp
== NE_EXPR
)
4074 /* If VAL is not inside VR, then they are always different. */
4075 if (compare_values_warnv (vr
->max
, val
, strict_overflow_p
) == -1
4076 || compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, val
, strict_overflow_p
) == 1)
4077 return boolean_true_node
;
4079 /* If VR represents exactly one value equal to VAL, then return
4081 if (compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, vr
->max
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0
4082 && compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, val
, strict_overflow_p
) == 0)
4083 return boolean_false_node
;
4085 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
4088 else if (comp
== LT_EXPR
|| comp
== LE_EXPR
)
4092 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return true. */
4093 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr
->max
, val
, strict_overflow_p
);
4094 if ((comp
== LT_EXPR
&& tst
== -1)
4095 || (comp
== LE_EXPR
&& (tst
== -1 || tst
== 0)))
4097 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr
))
4098 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
4099 return boolean_true_node
;
4102 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return false. */
4103 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, val
, strict_overflow_p
);
4104 if ((comp
== LT_EXPR
&& (tst
== 0 || tst
== 1))
4105 || (comp
== LE_EXPR
&& tst
== 1))
4107 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr
))
4108 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
4109 return boolean_false_node
;
4112 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4115 else if (comp
== GT_EXPR
|| comp
== GE_EXPR
)
4119 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return true. */
4120 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr
->min
, val
, strict_overflow_p
);
4121 if ((comp
== GT_EXPR
&& tst
== 1)
4122 || (comp
== GE_EXPR
&& (tst
== 0 || tst
== 1)))
4124 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr
))
4125 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
4126 return boolean_true_node
;
4129 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return false. */
4130 tst
= compare_values_warnv (vr
->max
, val
, strict_overflow_p
);
4131 if ((comp
== GT_EXPR
&& (tst
== -1 || tst
== 0))
4132 || (comp
== GE_EXPR
&& tst
== -1))
4134 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr
))
4135 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
4136 return boolean_false_node
;
4139 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4147 /* Debugging dumps. */
4149 void dump_value_range (FILE *, value_range_t
*);
4150 void debug_value_range (value_range_t
*);
4151 void dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *);
4152 void debug_all_value_ranges (void);
4153 void dump_vr_equiv (FILE *, bitmap
);
4154 void debug_vr_equiv (bitmap
);
4157 /* Dump value range VR to FILE. */
4160 dump_value_range (FILE *file
, value_range_t
*vr
)
4163 fprintf (file
, "[]");
4164 else if (vr
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
4165 fprintf (file
, "UNDEFINED");
4166 else if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
|| vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
4168 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (vr
->min
);
4170 fprintf (file
, "%s[", (vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
) ? "~" : "");
4172 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr
->min
))
4173 fprintf (file
, "-INF(OVF)");
4174 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
4175 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
)
4176 && vrp_val_is_min (vr
->min
))
4177 fprintf (file
, "-INF");
4179 print_generic_expr (file
, vr
->min
, 0);
4181 fprintf (file
, ", ");
4183 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr
->max
))
4184 fprintf (file
, "+INF(OVF)");
4185 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
4186 && vrp_val_is_max (vr
->max
))
4187 fprintf (file
, "+INF");
4189 print_generic_expr (file
, vr
->max
, 0);
4191 fprintf (file
, "]");
4198 fprintf (file
, " EQUIVALENCES: { ");
4200 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (vr
->equiv
, 0, i
, bi
)
4202 print_generic_expr (file
, ssa_name (i
), 0);
4203 fprintf (file
, " ");
4207 fprintf (file
, "} (%u elements)", c
);
4210 else if (vr
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
4211 fprintf (file
, "VARYING");
4213 fprintf (file
, "INVALID RANGE");
4217 /* Dump value range VR to stderr. */
4220 debug_value_range (value_range_t
*vr
)
4222 dump_value_range (stderr
, vr
);
4223 fprintf (stderr
, "\n");
4227 /* Dump value ranges of all SSA_NAMEs to FILE. */
4230 dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *file
)
4234 for (i
= 0; i
< num_vr_values
; i
++)
4238 print_generic_expr (file
, ssa_name (i
), 0);
4239 fprintf (file
, ": ");
4240 dump_value_range (file
, vr_value
[i
]);
4241 fprintf (file
, "\n");
4245 fprintf (file
, "\n");
4249 /* Dump all value ranges to stderr. */
4252 debug_all_value_ranges (void)
4254 dump_all_value_ranges (stderr
);
4258 /* Given a COND_EXPR COND of the form 'V OP W', and an SSA name V,
4259 create a new SSA name N and return the assertion assignment
4260 'V = ASSERT_EXPR <V, V OP W>'. */
4263 build_assert_expr_for (tree cond
, tree v
)
4268 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (v
) == SSA_NAME
4269 && COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond
));
4271 a
= build2 (ASSERT_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (v
), v
, cond
);
4272 assertion
= gimple_build_assign (NULL_TREE
, a
);
4274 /* The new ASSERT_EXPR, creates a new SSA name that replaces the
4275 operand of the ASSERT_EXPR. Create it so the new name and the old one
4276 are registered in the replacement table so that we can fix the SSA web
4277 after adding all the ASSERT_EXPRs. */
4278 create_new_def_for (v
, assertion
, NULL
);
4284 /* Return false if EXPR is a predicate expression involving floating
4288 fp_predicate (gimple stmt
)
4290 GIMPLE_CHECK (stmt
, GIMPLE_COND
);
4292 return FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt
)));
4296 /* If the range of values taken by OP can be inferred after STMT executes,
4297 return the comparison code (COMP_CODE_P) and value (VAL_P) that
4298 describes the inferred range. Return true if a range could be
4302 infer_value_range (gimple stmt
, tree op
, enum tree_code
*comp_code_p
, tree
*val_p
)
4305 *comp_code_p
= ERROR_MARK
;
4307 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
4309 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (op
))
4312 /* Similarly, don't infer anything from statements that may throw
4314 if (stmt_could_throw_p (stmt
))
4317 /* If STMT is the last statement of a basic block with no
4318 successors, there is no point inferring anything about any of its
4319 operands. We would not be able to find a proper insertion point
4320 for the assertion, anyway. */
4321 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt
) && EDGE_COUNT (gimple_bb (stmt
)->succs
) == 0)
4324 /* We can only assume that a pointer dereference will yield
4325 non-NULL if -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is enabled. */
4326 if (flag_delete_null_pointer_checks
4327 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op
))
4328 && gimple_code (stmt
) != GIMPLE_ASM
)
4330 unsigned num_uses
, num_loads
, num_stores
;
4332 count_uses_and_derefs (op
, stmt
, &num_uses
, &num_loads
, &num_stores
);
4333 if (num_loads
+ num_stores
> 0)
4335 *val_p
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op
), 0);
4336 *comp_code_p
= NE_EXPR
;
4345 void dump_asserts_for (FILE *, tree
);
4346 void debug_asserts_for (tree
);
4347 void dump_all_asserts (FILE *);
4348 void debug_all_asserts (void);
4350 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to FILE. */
4353 dump_asserts_for (FILE *file
, tree name
)
4357 fprintf (file
, "Assertions to be inserted for ");
4358 print_generic_expr (file
, name
, 0);
4359 fprintf (file
, "\n");
4361 loc
= asserts_for
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name
)];
4364 fprintf (file
, "\t");
4365 print_gimple_stmt (file
, gsi_stmt (loc
->si
), 0, 0);
4366 fprintf (file
, "\n\tBB #%d", loc
->bb
->index
);
4369 fprintf (file
, "\n\tEDGE %d->%d", loc
->e
->src
->index
,
4370 loc
->e
->dest
->index
);
4371 dump_edge_info (file
, loc
->e
, dump_flags
, 0);
4373 fprintf (file
, "\n\tPREDICATE: ");
4374 print_generic_expr (file
, name
, 0);
4375 fprintf (file
, " %s ", tree_code_name
[(int)loc
->comp_code
]);
4376 print_generic_expr (file
, loc
->val
, 0);
4377 fprintf (file
, "\n\n");
4381 fprintf (file
, "\n");
4385 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to stderr. */
4388 debug_asserts_for (tree name
)
4390 dump_asserts_for (stderr
, name
);
4394 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to FILE. */
4397 dump_all_asserts (FILE *file
)
4402 fprintf (file
, "\nASSERT_EXPRs to be inserted\n\n");
4403 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for
, 0, i
, bi
)
4404 dump_asserts_for (file
, ssa_name (i
));
4405 fprintf (file
, "\n");
4409 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to stderr. */
4412 debug_all_asserts (void)
4414 dump_all_asserts (stderr
);
4418 /* If NAME doesn't have an ASSERT_EXPR registered for asserting
4419 'EXPR COMP_CODE VAL' at a location that dominates block BB or
4420 E->DEST, then register this location as a possible insertion point
4421 for ASSERT_EXPR <NAME, EXPR COMP_CODE VAL>.
4423 BB, E and SI provide the exact insertion point for the new
4424 ASSERT_EXPR. If BB is NULL, then the ASSERT_EXPR is to be inserted
4425 on edge E. Otherwise, if E is NULL, the ASSERT_EXPR is inserted on
4426 BB. If SI points to a COND_EXPR or a SWITCH_EXPR statement, then E
4427 must not be NULL. */
4430 register_new_assert_for (tree name
, tree expr
,
4431 enum tree_code comp_code
,
4435 gimple_stmt_iterator si
)
4437 assert_locus_t n
, loc
, last_loc
;
4438 basic_block dest_bb
;
4440 gcc_checking_assert (bb
== NULL
|| e
== NULL
);
4443 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si
)) != GIMPLE_COND
4444 && gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si
)) != GIMPLE_SWITCH
);
4446 /* Never build an assert comparing against an integer constant with
4447 TREE_OVERFLOW set. This confuses our undefined overflow warning
4449 if (TREE_CODE (val
) == INTEGER_CST
4450 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val
))
4451 val
= build_int_cst_wide (TREE_TYPE (val
),
4452 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (val
), TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (val
));
4454 /* The new assertion A will be inserted at BB or E. We need to
4455 determine if the new location is dominated by a previously
4456 registered location for A. If we are doing an edge insertion,
4457 assume that A will be inserted at E->DEST. Note that this is not
4460 If E is a critical edge, it will be split. But even if E is
4461 split, the new block will dominate the same set of blocks that
4464 The reverse, however, is not true, blocks dominated by E->DEST
4465 will not be dominated by the new block created to split E. So,
4466 if the insertion location is on a critical edge, we will not use
4467 the new location to move another assertion previously registered
4468 at a block dominated by E->DEST. */
4469 dest_bb
= (bb
) ? bb
: e
->dest
;
4471 /* If NAME already has an ASSERT_EXPR registered for COMP_CODE and
4472 VAL at a block dominating DEST_BB, then we don't need to insert a new
4473 one. Similarly, if the same assertion already exists at a block
4474 dominated by DEST_BB and the new location is not on a critical
4475 edge, then update the existing location for the assertion (i.e.,
4476 move the assertion up in the dominance tree).
4478 Note, this is implemented as a simple linked list because there
4479 should not be more than a handful of assertions registered per
4480 name. If this becomes a performance problem, a table hashed by
4481 COMP_CODE and VAL could be implemented. */
4482 loc
= asserts_for
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name
)];
4486 if (loc
->comp_code
== comp_code
4488 || operand_equal_p (loc
->val
, val
, 0))
4489 && (loc
->expr
== expr
4490 || operand_equal_p (loc
->expr
, expr
, 0)))
4492 /* If E is not a critical edge and DEST_BB
4493 dominates the existing location for the assertion, move
4494 the assertion up in the dominance tree by updating its
4495 location information. */
4496 if ((e
== NULL
|| !EDGE_CRITICAL_P (e
))
4497 && dominated_by_p (CDI_DOMINATORS
, loc
->bb
, dest_bb
))
4506 /* Update the last node of the list and move to the next one. */
4511 /* If we didn't find an assertion already registered for
4512 NAME COMP_CODE VAL, add a new one at the end of the list of
4513 assertions associated with NAME. */
4514 n
= XNEW (struct assert_locus_d
);
4518 n
->comp_code
= comp_code
;
4526 asserts_for
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name
)] = n
;
4528 bitmap_set_bit (need_assert_for
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (name
));
4531 /* (COND_OP0 COND_CODE COND_OP1) is a predicate which uses NAME.
4532 Extract a suitable test code and value and store them into *CODE_P and
4533 *VAL_P so the predicate is normalized to NAME *CODE_P *VAL_P.
4535 If no extraction was possible, return FALSE, otherwise return TRUE.
4537 If INVERT is true, then we invert the result stored into *CODE_P. */
4540 extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (tree name
, enum tree_code cond_code
,
4541 tree cond_op0
, tree cond_op1
,
4542 bool invert
, enum tree_code
*code_p
,
4545 enum tree_code comp_code
;
4548 /* Otherwise, we have a comparison of the form NAME COMP VAL
4549 or VAL COMP NAME. */
4550 if (name
== cond_op1
)
4552 /* If the predicate is of the form VAL COMP NAME, flip
4553 COMP around because we need to register NAME as the
4554 first operand in the predicate. */
4555 comp_code
= swap_tree_comparison (cond_code
);
4560 /* The comparison is of the form NAME COMP VAL, so the
4561 comparison code remains unchanged. */
4562 comp_code
= cond_code
;
4566 /* Invert the comparison code as necessary. */
4568 comp_code
= invert_tree_comparison (comp_code
, 0);
4570 /* VRP does not handle float types. */
4571 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4574 /* Do not register always-false predicates.
4575 FIXME: this works around a limitation in fold() when dealing with
4576 enumerations. Given 'enum { N1, N2 } x;', fold will not
4577 fold 'if (x > N2)' to 'if (0)'. */
4578 if ((comp_code
== GT_EXPR
|| comp_code
== LT_EXPR
)
4579 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4581 tree min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val
));
4582 tree max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val
));
4584 if (comp_code
== GT_EXPR
4586 || compare_values (val
, max
) == 0))
4589 if (comp_code
== LT_EXPR
4591 || compare_values (val
, min
) == 0))
4594 *code_p
= comp_code
;
4599 /* Find out smallest RES where RES > VAL && (RES & MASK) == RES, if any
4600 (otherwise return VAL). VAL and MASK must be zero-extended for
4601 precision PREC. If SGNBIT is non-zero, first xor VAL with SGNBIT
4602 (to transform signed values into unsigned) and at the end xor
4606 masked_increment (double_int val
, double_int mask
, double_int sgnbit
,
4609 double_int bit
= double_int_one
, res
;
4613 for (i
= 0; i
< prec
; i
++, bit
+= bit
)
4616 if ((res
& bit
).is_zero ())
4618 res
= bit
- double_int_one
;
4619 res
= (val
+ bit
).and_not (res
);
4622 return res
^ sgnbit
;
4624 return val
^ sgnbit
;
4627 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
4628 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by BSI.
4629 Invert the condition COND if INVERT is true.
4630 Return true if an assertion for NAME could be registered. */
4633 register_edge_assert_for_2 (tree name
, edge e
, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi
,
4634 enum tree_code cond_code
,
4635 tree cond_op0
, tree cond_op1
, bool invert
)
4638 enum tree_code comp_code
;
4639 bool retval
= false;
4641 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name
, cond_code
,
4644 invert
, &comp_code
, &val
))
4647 /* Only register an ASSERT_EXPR if NAME was found in the sub-graph
4648 reachable from E. */
4649 if (live_on_edge (e
, name
)
4650 && !has_single_use (name
))
4652 register_new_assert_for (name
, name
, comp_code
, val
, NULL
, e
, bsi
);
4656 /* In the case of NAME <= CST and NAME being defined as
4657 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2 + CST2 we can assert NAME2 >= -CST2
4658 and NAME2 <= CST - CST2. We can do the same for NAME > CST.
4659 This catches range and anti-range tests. */
4660 if ((comp_code
== LE_EXPR
4661 || comp_code
== GT_EXPR
)
4662 && TREE_CODE (val
) == INTEGER_CST
4663 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4665 gimple def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name
);
4666 tree cst2
= NULL_TREE
, name2
= NULL_TREE
, name3
= NULL_TREE
;
4668 /* Extract CST2 from the (optional) addition. */
4669 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
)
4670 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
) == PLUS_EXPR
)
4672 name2
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
4673 cst2
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt
);
4674 if (TREE_CODE (name2
) == SSA_NAME
4675 && TREE_CODE (cst2
) == INTEGER_CST
)
4676 def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2
);
4679 /* Extract NAME2 from the (optional) sign-changing cast. */
4680 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt
))
4682 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
))
4683 && ! TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
)))
4684 && (TYPE_PRECISION (gimple_expr_type (def_stmt
))
4685 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
)))))
4686 name3
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
4689 /* If name3 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
4690 if (name3
!= NULL_TREE
4691 && TREE_CODE (name3
) == SSA_NAME
4692 && (cst2
== NULL_TREE
4693 || TREE_CODE (cst2
) == INTEGER_CST
)
4694 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name3
))
4695 && live_on_edge (e
, name3
)
4696 && !has_single_use (name3
))
4700 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4701 tmp
= build1 (NOP_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name
), name3
);
4702 if (cst2
!= NULL_TREE
)
4703 tmp
= build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name
), tmp
, cst2
);
4707 fprintf (dump_file
, "Adding assert for ");
4708 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, name3
, 0);
4709 fprintf (dump_file
, " from ");
4710 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, tmp
, 0);
4711 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
4714 register_new_assert_for (name3
, tmp
, comp_code
, val
, NULL
, e
, bsi
);
4719 /* If name2 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
4720 if (name2
!= NULL_TREE
4721 && TREE_CODE (name2
) == SSA_NAME
4722 && TREE_CODE (cst2
) == INTEGER_CST
4723 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4724 && live_on_edge (e
, name2
)
4725 && !has_single_use (name2
))
4729 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4731 if (TREE_TYPE (name
) != TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4732 tmp
= build1 (NOP_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name
), tmp
);
4733 if (cst2
!= NULL_TREE
)
4734 tmp
= build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name
), tmp
, cst2
);
4738 fprintf (dump_file
, "Adding assert for ");
4739 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, name2
, 0);
4740 fprintf (dump_file
, " from ");
4741 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, tmp
, 0);
4742 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
4745 register_new_assert_for (name2
, tmp
, comp_code
, val
, NULL
, e
, bsi
);
4751 /* In the case of post-in/decrement tests like if (i++) ... and uses
4752 of the in/decremented value on the edge the extra name we want to
4753 assert for is not on the def chain of the name compared. Instead
4754 it is in the set of use stmts. */
4755 if ((comp_code
== NE_EXPR
4756 || comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
)
4757 && TREE_CODE (val
) == INTEGER_CST
)
4759 imm_use_iterator ui
;
4761 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt
, ui
, name
)
4763 /* Cut off to use-stmts that are in the predecessor. */
4764 if (gimple_bb (use_stmt
) != e
->src
)
4767 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt
))
4770 enum tree_code code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt
);
4771 if (code
!= PLUS_EXPR
4772 && code
!= MINUS_EXPR
)
4775 tree cst
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (use_stmt
);
4776 if (TREE_CODE (cst
) != INTEGER_CST
)
4779 tree name2
= gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt
);
4780 if (live_on_edge (e
, name2
))
4782 cst
= int_const_binop (code
, val
, cst
);
4783 register_new_assert_for (name2
, name2
, comp_code
, cst
,
4790 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (comp_code
) == tcc_comparison
4791 && TREE_CODE (val
) == INTEGER_CST
)
4793 gimple def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name
);
4794 tree name2
= NULL_TREE
, names
[2], cst2
= NULL_TREE
;
4795 tree val2
= NULL_TREE
;
4796 double_int mask
= double_int_zero
;
4797 unsigned int prec
= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (val
));
4798 unsigned int nprec
= prec
;
4799 enum tree_code rhs_code
= ERROR_MARK
;
4801 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
))
4802 rhs_code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
);
4804 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined
4805 as NAME = (int) NAME2. */
4806 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
))
4807 && (comp_code
== LE_EXPR
|| comp_code
== LT_EXPR
4808 || comp_code
== GT_EXPR
|| comp_code
== GE_EXPR
)
4809 && gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt
))
4811 name2
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
4812 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code
)
4813 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4814 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4815 && prec
== TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4816 && (comp_code
== LE_EXPR
|| comp_code
== GT_EXPR
4817 || !tree_int_cst_equal (val
,
4818 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val
))))
4819 && live_on_edge (e
, name2
)
4820 && !has_single_use (name2
))
4823 enum tree_code new_comp_code
= comp_code
;
4825 cst
= fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2
),
4826 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val
)));
4827 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4828 tmp
= build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name2
), name2
, cst
);
4829 cst
= fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name2
), cst
,
4830 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2
), val
));
4831 if (comp_code
== LT_EXPR
|| comp_code
== GE_EXPR
)
4833 new_comp_code
= comp_code
== LT_EXPR
? LE_EXPR
: GT_EXPR
;
4834 cst
= fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (name2
), cst
,
4835 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (name2
), 1));
4840 fprintf (dump_file
, "Adding assert for ");
4841 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, name2
, 0);
4842 fprintf (dump_file
, " from ");
4843 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, tmp
, 0);
4844 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
4847 register_new_assert_for (name2
, tmp
, new_comp_code
, cst
, NULL
,
4854 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
4855 NAME = NAME2 >> CST2.
4857 Extract CST2 from the right shift. */
4858 if (rhs_code
== RSHIFT_EXPR
)
4860 name2
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
4861 cst2
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt
);
4862 if (TREE_CODE (name2
) == SSA_NAME
4863 && host_integerp (cst2
, 1)
4864 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4865 && IN_RANGE (tree_low_cst (cst2
, 1), 1, prec
- 1)
4866 && prec
<= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
4867 && prec
== GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4868 && live_on_edge (e
, name2
)
4869 && !has_single_use (name2
))
4871 mask
= double_int::mask (tree_low_cst (cst2
, 1));
4872 val2
= fold_binary (LSHIFT_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (val
), val
, cst2
);
4875 if (val2
!= NULL_TREE
4876 && TREE_CODE (val2
) == INTEGER_CST
4877 && simple_cst_equal (fold_build2 (RSHIFT_EXPR
,
4881 enum tree_code new_comp_code
= comp_code
;
4885 if (comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
|| comp_code
== NE_EXPR
)
4887 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4889 tree type
= build_nonstandard_integer_type (prec
, 1);
4890 tmp
= build1 (NOP_EXPR
, type
, name2
);
4891 val2
= fold_convert (type
, val2
);
4893 tmp
= fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (tmp
), tmp
, val2
);
4894 new_val
= double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (tmp
), mask
);
4895 new_comp_code
= comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
? LE_EXPR
: GT_EXPR
;
4897 else if (comp_code
== LT_EXPR
|| comp_code
== GE_EXPR
)
4902 = double_int::max_value (prec
, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
)));
4903 mask
|= tree_to_double_int (val2
);
4905 new_val
= NULL_TREE
;
4907 new_val
= double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (val2
), mask
);
4914 fprintf (dump_file
, "Adding assert for ");
4915 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, name2
, 0);
4916 fprintf (dump_file
, " from ");
4917 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, tmp
, 0);
4918 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
4921 register_new_assert_for (name2
, tmp
, new_comp_code
, new_val
,
4927 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
4928 NAME = NAME2 & CST2.
4930 Extract CST2 from the and.
4933 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2;
4934 casts where NAME's type is unsigned and has smaller precision
4935 than NAME2's type as if it was NAME = NAME2 & MASK. */
4936 names
[0] = NULL_TREE
;
4937 names
[1] = NULL_TREE
;
4939 if (rhs_code
== BIT_AND_EXPR
4940 || (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code
)
4941 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (val
)) == INTEGER_TYPE
4942 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
))
4943 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
)))
4947 name2
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
4948 if (rhs_code
== BIT_AND_EXPR
)
4949 cst2
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt
);
4952 cst2
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val
));
4953 nprec
= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2
));
4955 if (TREE_CODE (name2
) == SSA_NAME
4956 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4957 && TREE_CODE (cst2
) == INTEGER_CST
4958 && !integer_zerop (cst2
)
4959 && nprec
<= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
4961 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
))))
4963 gimple def_stmt2
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2
);
4964 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt2
))
4966 names
[1] = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt2
);
4967 if (!CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt2
))
4968 || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (names
[1]))
4969 || (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2
))
4970 != TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (names
[1])))
4971 || !live_on_edge (e
, names
[1])
4972 || has_single_use (names
[1]))
4973 names
[1] = NULL_TREE
;
4975 if (live_on_edge (e
, name2
)
4976 && !has_single_use (name2
))
4980 if (names
[0] || names
[1])
4982 double_int minv
, maxv
= double_int_zero
, valv
, cst2v
;
4983 double_int tem
, sgnbit
;
4984 bool valid_p
= false, valn
= false, cst2n
= false;
4985 enum tree_code ccode
= comp_code
;
4987 valv
= tree_to_double_int (val
).zext (nprec
);
4988 cst2v
= tree_to_double_int (cst2
).zext (nprec
);
4989 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val
)))
4991 valn
= valv
.sext (nprec
).is_negative ();
4992 cst2n
= cst2v
.sext (nprec
).is_negative ();
4994 /* If CST2 doesn't have most significant bit set,
4995 but VAL is negative, we have comparison like
4996 if ((x & 0x123) > -4) (always true). Just give up. */
5000 sgnbit
= double_int_one
.llshift (nprec
- 1, nprec
).zext (nprec
);
5002 sgnbit
= double_int_zero
;
5003 minv
= valv
& cst2v
;
5007 /* Minimum unsigned value for equality is VAL & CST2
5008 (should be equal to VAL, otherwise we probably should
5009 have folded the comparison into false) and
5010 maximum unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2. */
5011 maxv
= valv
| ~cst2v
;
5012 maxv
= maxv
.zext (nprec
);
5016 tem
= valv
| ~cst2v
;
5017 tem
= tem
.zext (nprec
);
5018 /* If VAL is 0, handle (X & CST2) != 0 as (X & CST2) > 0U. */
5019 if (valv
.is_zero ())
5022 sgnbit
= double_int_zero
;
5025 /* If (VAL | ~CST2) is all ones, handle it as
5026 (X & CST2) < VAL. */
5027 if (tem
== double_int::mask (nprec
))
5031 sgnbit
= double_int_zero
;
5035 && cst2v
.sext (nprec
).is_negative ())
5037 = double_int_one
.llshift (nprec
- 1, nprec
).zext (nprec
);
5038 if (!sgnbit
.is_zero ())
5046 if (tem
== double_int::mask (nprec
- 1))
5052 sgnbit
= double_int_zero
;
5056 /* Minimum unsigned value for >= if (VAL & CST2) == VAL
5057 is VAL and maximum unsigned value is ~0. For signed
5058 comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most significant bit
5059 set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has MSB set,
5060 the minimum is the same, and maximum is ~0U/2. */
5063 /* If (VAL & CST2) != VAL, X & CST2 can't be equal to
5065 minv
= masked_increment (valv
, cst2v
, sgnbit
, nprec
);
5069 maxv
= double_int::mask (nprec
- (cst2n
? 1 : 0));
5074 /* Find out smallest MINV where MINV > VAL
5075 && (MINV & CST2) == MINV, if any. If VAL is signed and
5076 CST2 has MSB set, compute it biased by 1 << (nprec - 1). */
5077 minv
= masked_increment (valv
, cst2v
, sgnbit
, nprec
);
5080 maxv
= double_int::mask (nprec
- (cst2n
? 1 : 0));
5084 /* Minimum unsigned value for <= is 0 and maximum
5085 unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5086 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5087 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5089 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5090 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5091 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5096 maxv
= masked_increment (valv
, cst2v
, sgnbit
, nprec
);
5099 maxv
-= double_int_one
;
5102 maxv
= maxv
.zext (nprec
);
5108 /* Minimum unsigned value for < is 0 and maximum
5109 unsigned value is (VAL-1) | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5110 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5111 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5113 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5114 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5115 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5124 maxv
= masked_increment (valv
, cst2v
, sgnbit
, nprec
);
5128 maxv
-= double_int_one
;
5130 maxv
= maxv
.zext (nprec
);
5138 && (maxv
- minv
).zext (nprec
) != double_int::mask (nprec
))
5140 tree tmp
, new_val
, type
;
5143 for (i
= 0; i
< 2; i
++)
5146 double_int maxv2
= maxv
;
5148 type
= TREE_TYPE (names
[i
]);
5149 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
))
5151 type
= build_nonstandard_integer_type (nprec
, 1);
5152 tmp
= build1 (NOP_EXPR
, type
, names
[i
]);
5154 if (!minv
.is_zero ())
5156 tmp
= build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, type
, tmp
,
5157 double_int_to_tree (type
, -minv
));
5158 maxv2
= maxv
- minv
;
5160 new_val
= double_int_to_tree (type
, maxv2
);
5164 fprintf (dump_file
, "Adding assert for ");
5165 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, names
[i
], 0);
5166 fprintf (dump_file
, " from ");
5167 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, tmp
, 0);
5168 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
5171 register_new_assert_for (names
[i
], tmp
, LE_EXPR
,
5172 new_val
, NULL
, e
, bsi
);
5182 /* OP is an operand of a truth value expression which is known to have
5183 a particular value. Register any asserts for OP and for any
5184 operands in OP's defining statement.
5186 If CODE is EQ_EXPR, then we want to register OP is zero (false),
5187 if CODE is NE_EXPR, then we want to register OP is nonzero (true). */
5190 register_edge_assert_for_1 (tree op
, enum tree_code code
,
5191 edge e
, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi
)
5193 bool retval
= false;
5196 enum tree_code rhs_code
;
5198 /* We only care about SSA_NAMEs. */
5199 if (TREE_CODE (op
) != SSA_NAME
)
5202 /* We know that OP will have a zero or nonzero value. If OP is used
5203 more than once go ahead and register an assert for OP.
5205 The FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH support is not helpful in this situation as
5206 it will always be set for OP (because OP is used in a COND_EXPR in
5208 if (!has_single_use (op
))
5210 val
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op
), 0);
5211 register_new_assert_for (op
, op
, code
, val
, NULL
, e
, bsi
);
5215 /* Now look at how OP is set. If it's set from a comparison,
5216 a truth operation or some bit operations, then we may be able
5217 to register information about the operands of that assignment. */
5218 op_def
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (op
);
5219 if (gimple_code (op_def
) != GIMPLE_ASSIGN
)
5222 rhs_code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
);
5224 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (rhs_code
) == tcc_comparison
)
5226 bool invert
= (code
== EQ_EXPR
? true : false);
5227 tree op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def
);
5228 tree op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def
);
5230 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
5231 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_2 (op0
, e
, bsi
, rhs_code
, op0
, op1
,
5233 if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
5234 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_2 (op1
, e
, bsi
, rhs_code
, op0
, op1
,
5237 else if ((code
== NE_EXPR
5238 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
) == BIT_AND_EXPR
)
5240 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
))
5242 /* Recurse on each operand. */
5243 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def
),
5245 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def
),
5248 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
) == BIT_NOT_EXPR
5249 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (op_def
))) == 1)
5251 /* Recurse, flipping CODE. */
5252 code
= invert_tree_comparison (code
, false);
5253 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def
),
5256 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
) == SSA_NAME
)
5258 /* Recurse through the copy. */
5259 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def
),
5262 else if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def
)))
5264 /* Recurse through the type conversion. */
5265 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def
),
5272 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
5273 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by SI.
5274 Return true if an assertion for NAME could be registered. */
5277 register_edge_assert_for (tree name
, edge e
, gimple_stmt_iterator si
,
5278 enum tree_code cond_code
, tree cond_op0
,
5282 enum tree_code comp_code
;
5283 bool retval
= false;
5284 bool is_else_edge
= (e
->flags
& EDGE_FALSE_VALUE
) != 0;
5286 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
5288 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (name
))
5291 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name
, cond_code
,
5297 /* Register ASSERT_EXPRs for name. */
5298 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_2 (name
, e
, si
, cond_code
, cond_op0
,
5299 cond_op1
, is_else_edge
);
5302 /* If COND is effectively an equality test of an SSA_NAME against
5303 the value zero or one, then we may be able to assert values
5304 for SSA_NAMEs which flow into COND. */
5306 /* In the case of NAME == 1 or NAME != 0, for BIT_AND_EXPR defining
5307 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_AND_EXPR
5308 have nonzero value. */
5309 if (((comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
&& integer_onep (val
))
5310 || (comp_code
== NE_EXPR
&& integer_zerop (val
))))
5312 gimple def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name
);
5314 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
)
5315 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
) == BIT_AND_EXPR
)
5317 tree op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
5318 tree op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt
);
5319 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0
, NE_EXPR
, e
, si
);
5320 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1
, NE_EXPR
, e
, si
);
5324 /* In the case of NAME == 0 or NAME != 1, for BIT_IOR_EXPR defining
5325 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_IOR_EXPR
5327 if (((comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
&& integer_zerop (val
))
5328 || (comp_code
== NE_EXPR
&& integer_onep (val
))))
5330 gimple def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name
);
5332 /* For BIT_IOR_EXPR only if NAME == 0 both operands have
5333 necessarily zero value, or if type-precision is one. */
5334 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
)
5335 && (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
5336 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name
)) == 1
5337 || comp_code
== EQ_EXPR
)))
5339 tree op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
5340 tree op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt
);
5341 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0
, EQ_EXPR
, e
, si
);
5342 retval
|= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1
, EQ_EXPR
, e
, si
);
5350 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5351 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5352 The last statement of BB must be a COND_EXPR.
5354 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5355 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5356 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5359 find_conditional_asserts (basic_block bb
, gimple last
)
5362 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi
;
5368 need_assert
= false;
5369 bsi
= gsi_for_stmt (last
);
5371 /* Look for uses of the operands in each of the sub-graphs
5372 rooted at BB. We need to check each of the outgoing edges
5373 separately, so that we know what kind of ASSERT_EXPR to
5375 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->succs
)
5380 /* Register the necessary assertions for each operand in the
5381 conditional predicate. */
5382 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op
, last
, iter
, SSA_OP_USE
)
5384 need_assert
|= register_edge_assert_for (op
, e
, bsi
,
5385 gimple_cond_code (last
),
5386 gimple_cond_lhs (last
),
5387 gimple_cond_rhs (last
));
5400 /* Compare two case labels sorting first by the destination bb index
5401 and then by the case value. */
5404 compare_case_labels (const void *p1
, const void *p2
)
5406 const struct case_info
*ci1
= (const struct case_info
*) p1
;
5407 const struct case_info
*ci2
= (const struct case_info
*) p2
;
5408 int idx1
= ci1
->bb
->index
;
5409 int idx2
= ci2
->bb
->index
;
5413 else if (idx1
== idx2
)
5415 /* Make sure the default label is first in a group. */
5416 if (!CASE_LOW (ci1
->expr
))
5418 else if (!CASE_LOW (ci2
->expr
))
5421 return tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (ci1
->expr
),
5422 CASE_LOW (ci2
->expr
));
5428 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5429 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5430 The last statement of BB must be a SWITCH_EXPR.
5432 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5433 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5434 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5437 find_switch_asserts (basic_block bb
, gimple last
)
5440 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi
;
5443 struct case_info
*ci
;
5444 size_t n
= gimple_switch_num_labels (last
);
5445 #if GCC_VERSION >= 4000
5448 /* Work around GCC 3.4 bug (PR 37086). */
5449 volatile unsigned int idx
;
5452 need_assert
= false;
5453 bsi
= gsi_for_stmt (last
);
5454 op
= gimple_switch_index (last
);
5455 if (TREE_CODE (op
) != SSA_NAME
)
5458 /* Build a vector of case labels sorted by destination label. */
5459 ci
= XNEWVEC (struct case_info
, n
);
5460 for (idx
= 0; idx
< n
; ++idx
)
5462 ci
[idx
].expr
= gimple_switch_label (last
, idx
);
5463 ci
[idx
].bb
= label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (ci
[idx
].expr
));
5465 qsort (ci
, n
, sizeof (struct case_info
), compare_case_labels
);
5467 for (idx
= 0; idx
< n
; ++idx
)
5470 tree cl
= ci
[idx
].expr
;
5471 basic_block cbb
= ci
[idx
].bb
;
5473 min
= CASE_LOW (cl
);
5474 max
= CASE_HIGH (cl
);
5476 /* If there are multiple case labels with the same destination
5477 we need to combine them to a single value range for the edge. */
5478 if (idx
+ 1 < n
&& cbb
== ci
[idx
+ 1].bb
)
5480 /* Skip labels until the last of the group. */
5483 } while (idx
< n
&& cbb
== ci
[idx
].bb
);
5486 /* Pick up the maximum of the case label range. */
5487 if (CASE_HIGH (ci
[idx
].expr
))
5488 max
= CASE_HIGH (ci
[idx
].expr
);
5490 max
= CASE_LOW (ci
[idx
].expr
);
5493 /* Nothing to do if the range includes the default label until we
5494 can register anti-ranges. */
5495 if (min
== NULL_TREE
)
5498 /* Find the edge to register the assert expr on. */
5499 e
= find_edge (bb
, cbb
);
5501 /* Register the necessary assertions for the operand in the
5503 need_assert
|= register_edge_assert_for (op
, e
, bsi
,
5504 max
? GE_EXPR
: EQ_EXPR
,
5506 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op
),
5510 need_assert
|= register_edge_assert_for (op
, e
, bsi
, LE_EXPR
,
5512 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op
),
5522 /* Traverse all the statements in block BB looking for statements that
5523 may generate useful assertions for the SSA names in their operand.
5524 If a statement produces a useful assertion A for name N_i, then the
5525 list of assertions already generated for N_i is scanned to
5526 determine if A is actually needed.
5528 If N_i already had the assertion A at a location dominating the
5529 current location, then nothing needs to be done. Otherwise, the
5530 new location for A is recorded instead.
5532 1- For every statement S in BB, all the variables used by S are
5533 added to bitmap FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5535 2- If statement S uses an operand N in a way that exposes a known
5536 value range for N, then if N was not already generated by an
5537 ASSERT_EXPR, create a new assert location for N. For instance,
5538 if N is a pointer and the statement dereferences it, we can
5539 assume that N is not NULL.
5541 3- COND_EXPRs are a special case of #2. We can derive range
5542 information from the predicate but need to insert different
5543 ASSERT_EXPRs for each of the sub-graphs rooted at the
5544 conditional block. If the last statement of BB is a conditional
5545 expression of the form 'X op Y', then
5547 a) Remove X and Y from the set FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5549 b) If the conditional is the only entry point to the sub-graph
5550 corresponding to the THEN_CLAUSE, recurse into it. On
5551 return, if X and/or Y are marked in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH, then
5552 an ASSERT_EXPR is added for the corresponding variable.
5554 c) Repeat step (b) on the ELSE_CLAUSE.
5556 d) Mark X and Y in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5565 In this case, an assertion on the THEN clause is useful to
5566 determine that 'a' is always 9 on that edge. However, an assertion
5567 on the ELSE clause would be unnecessary.
5569 4- If BB does not end in a conditional expression, then we recurse
5570 into BB's dominator children.
5572 At the end of the recursive traversal, every SSA name will have a
5573 list of locations where ASSERT_EXPRs should be added. When a new
5574 location for name N is found, it is registered by calling
5575 register_new_assert_for. That function keeps track of all the
5576 registered assertions to prevent adding unnecessary assertions.
5577 For instance, if a pointer P_4 is dereferenced more than once in a
5578 dominator tree, only the location dominating all the dereference of
5579 P_4 will receive an ASSERT_EXPR.
5581 If this function returns true, then it means that there are names
5582 for which we need to generate ASSERT_EXPRs. Those assertions are
5583 inserted by process_assert_insertions. */
5586 find_assert_locations_1 (basic_block bb
, sbitmap live
)
5588 gimple_stmt_iterator si
;
5592 need_assert
= false;
5593 last
= last_stmt (bb
);
5595 /* If BB's last statement is a conditional statement involving integer
5596 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
5598 && gimple_code (last
) == GIMPLE_COND
5599 && !fp_predicate (last
)
5600 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last
, SSA_OP_USE
))
5601 need_assert
|= find_conditional_asserts (bb
, last
);
5603 /* If BB's last statement is a switch statement involving integer
5604 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
5606 && gimple_code (last
) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
5607 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last
, SSA_OP_USE
))
5608 need_assert
|= find_switch_asserts (bb
, last
);
5610 /* Traverse all the statements in BB marking used names and looking
5611 for statements that may infer assertions for their used operands. */
5612 for (si
= gsi_last_bb (bb
); !gsi_end_p (si
); gsi_prev (&si
))
5618 stmt
= gsi_stmt (si
);
5620 if (is_gimple_debug (stmt
))
5623 /* See if we can derive an assertion for any of STMT's operands. */
5624 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op
, stmt
, i
, SSA_OP_USE
)
5627 enum tree_code comp_code
;
5629 /* If op is not live beyond this stmt, do not bother to insert
5631 if (!bitmap_bit_p (live
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op
)))
5634 /* If OP is used in such a way that we can infer a value
5635 range for it, and we don't find a previous assertion for
5636 it, create a new assertion location node for OP. */
5637 if (infer_value_range (stmt
, op
, &comp_code
, &value
))
5639 /* If we are able to infer a nonzero value range for OP,
5640 then walk backwards through the use-def chain to see if OP
5641 was set via a typecast.
5643 If so, then we can also infer a nonzero value range
5644 for the operand of the NOP_EXPR. */
5645 if (comp_code
== NE_EXPR
&& integer_zerop (value
))
5648 gimple def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t
);
5650 while (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
)
5651 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
) == NOP_EXPR
5653 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
)) == SSA_NAME
5655 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
))))
5657 t
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
5658 def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t
);
5660 /* Note we want to register the assert for the
5661 operand of the NOP_EXPR after SI, not after the
5663 if (! has_single_use (t
))
5665 register_new_assert_for (t
, t
, comp_code
, value
,
5672 register_new_assert_for (op
, op
, comp_code
, value
, bb
, NULL
, si
);
5678 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op
, stmt
, i
, SSA_OP_USE
)
5679 bitmap_set_bit (live
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op
));
5680 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op
, stmt
, i
, SSA_OP_DEF
)
5681 bitmap_clear_bit (live
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op
));
5684 /* Traverse all PHI nodes in BB, updating live. */
5685 for (si
= gsi_start_phis (bb
); !gsi_end_p(si
); gsi_next (&si
))
5687 use_operand_p arg_p
;
5689 gimple phi
= gsi_stmt (si
);
5690 tree res
= gimple_phi_result (phi
);
5692 if (virtual_operand_p (res
))
5695 FOR_EACH_PHI_ARG (arg_p
, phi
, i
, SSA_OP_USE
)
5697 tree arg
= USE_FROM_PTR (arg_p
);
5698 if (TREE_CODE (arg
) == SSA_NAME
)
5699 bitmap_set_bit (live
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (arg
));
5702 bitmap_clear_bit (live
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (res
));
5708 /* Do an RPO walk over the function computing SSA name liveness
5709 on-the-fly and deciding on assert expressions to insert.
5710 Returns true if there are assert expressions to be inserted. */
5713 find_assert_locations (void)
5715 int *rpo
= XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block
);
5716 int *bb_rpo
= XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block
);
5717 int *last_rpo
= XCNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block
);
5721 live
= XCNEWVEC (sbitmap
, last_basic_block
);
5722 rpo_cnt
= pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL
, rpo
, false);
5723 for (i
= 0; i
< rpo_cnt
; ++i
)
5726 need_asserts
= false;
5727 for (i
= rpo_cnt
- 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
5729 basic_block bb
= BASIC_BLOCK (rpo
[i
]);
5735 live
[rpo
[i
]] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names
);
5736 bitmap_clear (live
[rpo
[i
]]);
5739 /* Process BB and update the live information with uses in
5741 need_asserts
|= find_assert_locations_1 (bb
, live
[rpo
[i
]]);
5743 /* Merge liveness into the predecessor blocks and free it. */
5744 if (!bitmap_empty_p (live
[rpo
[i
]]))
5747 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
5749 int pred
= e
->src
->index
;
5750 if ((e
->flags
& EDGE_DFS_BACK
) || pred
== ENTRY_BLOCK
)
5755 live
[pred
] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names
);
5756 bitmap_clear (live
[pred
]);
5758 bitmap_ior (live
[pred
], live
[pred
], live
[rpo
[i
]]);
5760 if (bb_rpo
[pred
] < pred_rpo
)
5761 pred_rpo
= bb_rpo
[pred
];
5764 /* Record the RPO number of the last visited block that needs
5765 live information from this block. */
5766 last_rpo
[rpo
[i
]] = pred_rpo
;
5770 sbitmap_free (live
[rpo
[i
]]);
5771 live
[rpo
[i
]] = NULL
;
5774 /* We can free all successors live bitmaps if all their
5775 predecessors have been visited already. */
5776 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->succs
)
5777 if (last_rpo
[e
->dest
->index
] == i
5778 && live
[e
->dest
->index
])
5780 sbitmap_free (live
[e
->dest
->index
]);
5781 live
[e
->dest
->index
] = NULL
;
5786 XDELETEVEC (bb_rpo
);
5787 XDELETEVEC (last_rpo
);
5788 for (i
= 0; i
< last_basic_block
; ++i
)
5790 sbitmap_free (live
[i
]);
5793 return need_asserts
;
5796 /* Create an ASSERT_EXPR for NAME and insert it in the location
5797 indicated by LOC. Return true if we made any edge insertions. */
5800 process_assert_insertions_for (tree name
, assert_locus_t loc
)
5802 /* Build the comparison expression NAME_i COMP_CODE VAL. */
5809 /* If we have X <=> X do not insert an assert expr for that. */
5810 if (loc
->expr
== loc
->val
)
5813 cond
= build2 (loc
->comp_code
, boolean_type_node
, loc
->expr
, loc
->val
);
5814 assert_stmt
= build_assert_expr_for (cond
, name
);
5817 /* We have been asked to insert the assertion on an edge. This
5818 is used only by COND_EXPR and SWITCH_EXPR assertions. */
5819 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc
->si
)) == GIMPLE_COND
5820 || (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc
->si
))
5823 gsi_insert_on_edge (loc
->e
, assert_stmt
);
5827 /* Otherwise, we can insert right after LOC->SI iff the
5828 statement must not be the last statement in the block. */
5829 stmt
= gsi_stmt (loc
->si
);
5830 if (!stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt
))
5832 gsi_insert_after (&loc
->si
, assert_stmt
, GSI_SAME_STMT
);
5836 /* If STMT must be the last statement in BB, we can only insert new
5837 assertions on the non-abnormal edge out of BB. Note that since
5838 STMT is not control flow, there may only be one non-abnormal edge
5840 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, loc
->bb
->succs
)
5841 if (!(e
->flags
& EDGE_ABNORMAL
))
5843 gsi_insert_on_edge (e
, assert_stmt
);
5851 /* Process all the insertions registered for every name N_i registered
5852 in NEED_ASSERT_FOR. The list of assertions to be inserted are
5853 found in ASSERTS_FOR[i]. */
5856 process_assert_insertions (void)
5860 bool update_edges_p
= false;
5861 int num_asserts
= 0;
5863 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5864 dump_all_asserts (dump_file
);
5866 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for
, 0, i
, bi
)
5868 assert_locus_t loc
= asserts_for
[i
];
5873 assert_locus_t next
= loc
->next
;
5874 update_edges_p
|= process_assert_insertions_for (ssa_name (i
), loc
);
5882 gsi_commit_edge_inserts ();
5884 statistics_counter_event (cfun
, "Number of ASSERT_EXPR expressions inserted",
5889 /* Traverse the flowgraph looking for conditional jumps to insert range
5890 expressions. These range expressions are meant to provide information
5891 to optimizations that need to reason in terms of value ranges. They
5892 will not be expanded into RTL. For instance, given:
5901 this pass will transform the code into:
5907 x = ASSERT_EXPR <x, x < y>
5912 y = ASSERT_EXPR <y, x <= y>
5916 The idea is that once copy and constant propagation have run, other
5917 optimizations will be able to determine what ranges of values can 'x'
5918 take in different paths of the code, simply by checking the reaching
5919 definition of 'x'. */
5922 insert_range_assertions (void)
5924 need_assert_for
= BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL
);
5925 asserts_for
= XCNEWVEC (assert_locus_t
, num_ssa_names
);
5927 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS
);
5929 if (find_assert_locations ())
5931 process_assert_insertions ();
5932 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa_no_phi
);
5935 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5937 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nSSA form after inserting ASSERT_EXPRs\n");
5938 dump_function_to_file (current_function_decl
, dump_file
, dump_flags
);
5942 BITMAP_FREE (need_assert_for
);
5945 /* Checks one ARRAY_REF in REF, located at LOCUS. Ignores flexible arrays
5946 and "struct" hacks. If VRP can determine that the
5947 array subscript is a constant, check if it is outside valid
5948 range. If the array subscript is a RANGE, warn if it is
5949 non-overlapping with valid range.
5950 IGNORE_OFF_BY_ONE is true if the ARRAY_REF is inside a ADDR_EXPR. */
5953 check_array_ref (location_t location
, tree ref
, bool ignore_off_by_one
)
5955 value_range_t
* vr
= NULL
;
5956 tree low_sub
, up_sub
;
5957 tree low_bound
, up_bound
, up_bound_p1
;
5960 if (TREE_NO_WARNING (ref
))
5963 low_sub
= up_sub
= TREE_OPERAND (ref
, 1);
5964 up_bound
= array_ref_up_bound (ref
);
5966 /* Can not check flexible arrays. */
5968 || TREE_CODE (up_bound
) != INTEGER_CST
)
5971 /* Accesses to trailing arrays via pointers may access storage
5972 beyond the types array bounds. */
5973 base
= get_base_address (ref
);
5974 if (base
&& TREE_CODE (base
) == MEM_REF
)
5976 tree cref
, next
= NULL_TREE
;
5978 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (ref
, 0)) != COMPONENT_REF
)
5981 cref
= TREE_OPERAND (ref
, 0);
5982 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (cref
, 0))) == RECORD_TYPE
)
5983 for (next
= DECL_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (cref
, 1));
5984 next
&& TREE_CODE (next
) != FIELD_DECL
;
5985 next
= DECL_CHAIN (next
))
5988 /* If this is the last field in a struct type or a field in a
5989 union type do not warn. */
5994 low_bound
= array_ref_low_bound (ref
);
5995 up_bound_p1
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, up_bound
, integer_one_node
);
5997 if (TREE_CODE (low_sub
) == SSA_NAME
)
5999 vr
= get_value_range (low_sub
);
6000 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
|| vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
6002 low_sub
= vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
? vr
->max
: vr
->min
;
6003 up_sub
= vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
? vr
->min
: vr
->max
;
6007 if (vr
&& vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
6009 if (TREE_CODE (up_sub
) == INTEGER_CST
6010 && tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound
, up_sub
)
6011 && TREE_CODE (low_sub
) == INTEGER_CST
6012 && tree_int_cst_lt (low_sub
, low_bound
))
6014 warning_at (location
, OPT_Warray_bounds
,
6015 "array subscript is outside array bounds");
6016 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref
) = 1;
6019 else if (TREE_CODE (up_sub
) == INTEGER_CST
6020 && (ignore_off_by_one
6021 ? (tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound
, up_sub
)
6022 && !tree_int_cst_equal (up_bound_p1
, up_sub
))
6023 : (tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound
, up_sub
)
6024 || tree_int_cst_equal (up_bound_p1
, up_sub
))))
6026 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6028 fprintf (dump_file
, "Array bound warning for ");
6029 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE
, TDF_SLIM
, ref
);
6031 warning_at (location
, OPT_Warray_bounds
,
6032 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6033 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref
) = 1;
6035 else if (TREE_CODE (low_sub
) == INTEGER_CST
6036 && tree_int_cst_lt (low_sub
, low_bound
))
6038 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6040 fprintf (dump_file
, "Array bound warning for ");
6041 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE
, TDF_SLIM
, ref
);
6043 warning_at (location
, OPT_Warray_bounds
,
6044 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6045 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref
) = 1;
6049 /* Searches if the expr T, located at LOCATION computes
6050 address of an ARRAY_REF, and call check_array_ref on it. */
6053 search_for_addr_array (tree t
, location_t location
)
6055 while (TREE_CODE (t
) == SSA_NAME
)
6057 gimple g
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t
);
6059 if (gimple_code (g
) != GIMPLE_ASSIGN
)
6062 if (get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (g
))
6063 != GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
)
6066 t
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (g
);
6070 /* We are only interested in addresses of ARRAY_REF's. */
6071 if (TREE_CODE (t
) != ADDR_EXPR
)
6074 /* Check each ARRAY_REFs in the reference chain. */
6077 if (TREE_CODE (t
) == ARRAY_REF
)
6078 check_array_ref (location
, t
, true /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6080 t
= TREE_OPERAND (t
, 0);
6082 while (handled_component_p (t
));
6084 if (TREE_CODE (t
) == MEM_REF
6085 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (t
, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6086 && !TREE_NO_WARNING (t
))
6088 tree tem
= TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (t
, 0), 0);
6089 tree low_bound
, up_bound
, el_sz
;
6091 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem
)) != ARRAY_TYPE
6092 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem
))) == ARRAY_TYPE
6093 || !TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem
)))
6096 low_bound
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem
)));
6097 up_bound
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem
)));
6098 el_sz
= TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem
)));
6100 || TREE_CODE (low_bound
) != INTEGER_CST
6102 || TREE_CODE (up_bound
) != INTEGER_CST
6104 || TREE_CODE (el_sz
) != INTEGER_CST
)
6107 idx
= mem_ref_offset (t
);
6108 idx
= idx
.sdiv (tree_to_double_int (el_sz
), TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
);
6109 if (idx
.slt (double_int_zero
))
6111 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6113 fprintf (dump_file
, "Array bound warning for ");
6114 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE
, TDF_SLIM
, t
);
6116 warning_at (location
, OPT_Warray_bounds
,
6117 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6118 TREE_NO_WARNING (t
) = 1;
6120 else if (idx
.sgt (tree_to_double_int (up_bound
)
6121 - tree_to_double_int (low_bound
)
6124 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6126 fprintf (dump_file
, "Array bound warning for ");
6127 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE
, TDF_SLIM
, t
);
6129 warning_at (location
, OPT_Warray_bounds
,
6130 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6131 TREE_NO_WARNING (t
) = 1;
6136 /* walk_tree() callback that checks if *TP is
6137 an ARRAY_REF inside an ADDR_EXPR (in which an array
6138 subscript one outside the valid range is allowed). Call
6139 check_array_ref for each ARRAY_REF found. The location is
6143 check_array_bounds (tree
*tp
, int *walk_subtree
, void *data
)
6146 struct walk_stmt_info
*wi
= (struct walk_stmt_info
*) data
;
6147 location_t location
;
6149 if (EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (t
))
6150 location
= EXPR_LOCATION (t
);
6153 location_t
*locp
= (location_t
*) wi
->info
;
6157 *walk_subtree
= TRUE
;
6159 if (TREE_CODE (t
) == ARRAY_REF
)
6160 check_array_ref (location
, t
, false /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6162 if (TREE_CODE (t
) == MEM_REF
6163 || (TREE_CODE (t
) == RETURN_EXPR
&& TREE_OPERAND (t
, 0)))
6164 search_for_addr_array (TREE_OPERAND (t
, 0), location
);
6166 if (TREE_CODE (t
) == ADDR_EXPR
)
6167 *walk_subtree
= FALSE
;
6172 /* Walk over all statements of all reachable BBs and call check_array_bounds
6176 check_all_array_refs (void)
6179 gimple_stmt_iterator si
;
6185 bool executable
= false;
6187 /* Skip blocks that were found to be unreachable. */
6188 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
6189 executable
|= !!(e
->flags
& EDGE_EXECUTABLE
);
6193 for (si
= gsi_start_bb (bb
); !gsi_end_p (si
); gsi_next (&si
))
6195 gimple stmt
= gsi_stmt (si
);
6196 struct walk_stmt_info wi
;
6197 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt
))
6200 if (is_gimple_call (stmt
))
6203 size_t n
= gimple_call_num_args (stmt
);
6204 for (i
= 0; i
< n
; i
++)
6206 tree arg
= gimple_call_arg (stmt
, i
);
6207 search_for_addr_array (arg
, gimple_location (stmt
));
6212 memset (&wi
, 0, sizeof (wi
));
6213 wi
.info
= CONST_CAST (void *, (const void *)
6214 gimple_location_ptr (stmt
));
6216 walk_gimple_op (gsi_stmt (si
),
6224 /* Convert range assertion expressions into the implied copies and
6225 copy propagate away the copies. Doing the trivial copy propagation
6226 here avoids the need to run the full copy propagation pass after
6229 FIXME, this will eventually lead to copy propagation removing the
6230 names that had useful range information attached to them. For
6231 instance, if we had the assertion N_i = ASSERT_EXPR <N_j, N_j > 3>,
6232 then N_i will have the range [3, +INF].
6234 However, by converting the assertion into the implied copy
6235 operation N_i = N_j, we will then copy-propagate N_j into the uses
6236 of N_i and lose the range information. We may want to hold on to
6237 ASSERT_EXPRs a little while longer as the ranges could be used in
6238 things like jump threading.
6240 The problem with keeping ASSERT_EXPRs around is that passes after
6241 VRP need to handle them appropriately.
6243 Another approach would be to make the range information a first
6244 class property of the SSA_NAME so that it can be queried from
6245 any pass. This is made somewhat more complex by the need for
6246 multiple ranges to be associated with one SSA_NAME. */
6249 remove_range_assertions (void)
6252 gimple_stmt_iterator si
;
6254 /* Note that the BSI iterator bump happens at the bottom of the
6255 loop and no bump is necessary if we're removing the statement
6256 referenced by the current BSI. */
6258 for (si
= gsi_start_bb (bb
); !gsi_end_p (si
);)
6260 gimple stmt
= gsi_stmt (si
);
6263 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
)
6264 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
) == ASSERT_EXPR
)
6266 tree rhs
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
6268 tree cond
= fold (ASSERT_EXPR_COND (rhs
));
6269 use_operand_p use_p
;
6270 imm_use_iterator iter
;
6272 gcc_assert (cond
!= boolean_false_node
);
6274 /* Propagate the RHS into every use of the LHS. */
6275 var
= ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (rhs
);
6276 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt
, iter
,
6277 gimple_assign_lhs (stmt
))
6278 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_ON_STMT (use_p
, iter
)
6280 SET_USE (use_p
, var
);
6281 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (var
) == SSA_NAME
);
6284 /* And finally, remove the copy, it is not needed. */
6285 gsi_remove (&si
, true);
6286 release_defs (stmt
);
6294 /* Return true if STMT is interesting for VRP. */
6297 stmt_interesting_for_vrp (gimple stmt
)
6299 if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_PHI
)
6301 tree res
= gimple_phi_result (stmt
);
6302 return (!virtual_operand_p (res
)
6303 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res
))
6304 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res
))));
6306 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
) || is_gimple_call (stmt
))
6308 tree lhs
= gimple_get_lhs (stmt
);
6310 /* In general, assignments with virtual operands are not useful
6311 for deriving ranges, with the obvious exception of calls to
6312 builtin functions. */
6313 if (lhs
&& TREE_CODE (lhs
) == SSA_NAME
6314 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs
))
6315 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs
)))
6316 && ((is_gimple_call (stmt
)
6317 && gimple_call_fndecl (stmt
) != NULL_TREE
6318 && DECL_BUILT_IN (gimple_call_fndecl (stmt
)))
6319 || !gimple_vuse (stmt
)))
6322 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_COND
6323 || gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
)
6330 /* Initialize local data structures for VRP. */
6333 vrp_initialize (void)
6337 values_propagated
= false;
6338 num_vr_values
= num_ssa_names
;
6339 vr_value
= XCNEWVEC (value_range_t
*, num_vr_values
);
6340 vr_phi_edge_counts
= XCNEWVEC (int, num_ssa_names
);
6344 gimple_stmt_iterator si
;
6346 for (si
= gsi_start_phis (bb
); !gsi_end_p (si
); gsi_next (&si
))
6348 gimple phi
= gsi_stmt (si
);
6349 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (phi
))
6351 tree lhs
= PHI_RESULT (phi
);
6352 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (lhs
));
6353 prop_set_simulate_again (phi
, false);
6356 prop_set_simulate_again (phi
, true);
6359 for (si
= gsi_start_bb (bb
); !gsi_end_p (si
); gsi_next (&si
))
6361 gimple stmt
= gsi_stmt (si
);
6363 /* If the statement is a control insn, then we do not
6364 want to avoid simulating the statement once. Failure
6365 to do so means that those edges will never get added. */
6366 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt
))
6367 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt
, true);
6368 else if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt
))
6372 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def
, stmt
, i
, SSA_OP_DEF
)
6373 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def
));
6374 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt
, false);
6377 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt
, true);
6382 /* Return the singleton value-range for NAME or NAME. */
6385 vrp_valueize (tree name
)
6387 if (TREE_CODE (name
) == SSA_NAME
)
6389 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (name
);
6390 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
6391 && (vr
->min
== vr
->max
6392 || operand_equal_p (vr
->min
, vr
->max
, 0)))
6398 /* Visit assignment STMT. If it produces an interesting range, record
6399 the SSA name in *OUTPUT_P. */
6401 static enum ssa_prop_result
6402 vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (gimple stmt
, tree
*output_p
)
6406 enum gimple_code code
= gimple_code (stmt
);
6407 lhs
= gimple_get_lhs (stmt
);
6409 /* We only keep track of ranges in integral and pointer types. */
6410 if (TREE_CODE (lhs
) == SSA_NAME
6411 && ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs
))
6412 /* It is valid to have NULL MIN/MAX values on a type. See
6413 build_range_type. */
6414 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs
))
6415 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs
)))
6416 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs
))))
6418 value_range_t new_vr
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
6420 /* Try folding the statement to a constant first. */
6421 tree tem
= gimple_fold_stmt_to_constant (stmt
, vrp_valueize
);
6422 if (tem
&& !is_overflow_infinity (tem
))
6423 set_value_range (&new_vr
, VR_RANGE
, tem
, tem
, NULL
);
6424 /* Then dispatch to value-range extracting functions. */
6425 else if (code
== GIMPLE_CALL
)
6426 extract_range_basic (&new_vr
, stmt
);
6428 extract_range_from_assignment (&new_vr
, stmt
);
6430 if (update_value_range (lhs
, &new_vr
))
6434 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6436 fprintf (dump_file
, "Found new range for ");
6437 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, lhs
, 0);
6438 fprintf (dump_file
, ": ");
6439 dump_value_range (dump_file
, &new_vr
);
6440 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n\n");
6443 if (new_vr
.type
== VR_VARYING
)
6444 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
6446 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING
;
6449 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING
;
6452 /* Every other statement produces no useful ranges. */
6453 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def
, stmt
, iter
, SSA_OP_DEF
)
6454 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def
));
6456 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
6459 /* Helper that gets the value range of the SSA_NAME with version I
6460 or a symbolic range containing the SSA_NAME only if the value range
6461 is varying or undefined. */
6463 static inline value_range_t
6464 get_vr_for_comparison (int i
)
6466 value_range_t vr
= *get_value_range (ssa_name (i
));
6468 /* If name N_i does not have a valid range, use N_i as its own
6469 range. This allows us to compare against names that may
6470 have N_i in their ranges. */
6471 if (vr
.type
== VR_VARYING
|| vr
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
6474 vr
.min
= ssa_name (i
);
6475 vr
.max
= ssa_name (i
);
6481 /* Compare all the value ranges for names equivalent to VAR with VAL
6482 using comparison code COMP. Return the same value returned by
6483 compare_range_with_value, including the setting of
6484 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P. */
6487 compare_name_with_value (enum tree_code comp
, tree var
, tree val
,
6488 bool *strict_overflow_p
)
6494 int used_strict_overflow
;
6496 value_range_t equiv_vr
;
6498 /* Get the set of equivalences for VAR. */
6499 e
= get_value_range (var
)->equiv
;
6501 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
6502 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
6503 used_strict_overflow
= -1;
6505 /* Compare vars' value range with val. */
6506 equiv_vr
= get_vr_for_comparison (SSA_NAME_VERSION (var
));
6508 retval
= compare_range_with_value (comp
, &equiv_vr
, val
, &sop
);
6510 used_strict_overflow
= sop
? 1 : 0;
6512 /* If the equiv set is empty we have done all work we need to do. */
6516 && used_strict_overflow
> 0)
6517 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
6521 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e
, 0, i
, bi
)
6523 equiv_vr
= get_vr_for_comparison (i
);
6525 t
= compare_range_with_value (comp
, &equiv_vr
, val
, &sop
);
6528 /* If we get different answers from different members
6529 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
6530 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
6531 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
6541 used_strict_overflow
= 0;
6542 else if (used_strict_overflow
< 0)
6543 used_strict_overflow
= 1;
6548 && used_strict_overflow
> 0)
6549 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
6555 /* Given a comparison code COMP and names N1 and N2, compare all the
6556 ranges equivalent to N1 against all the ranges equivalent to N2
6557 to determine the value of N1 COMP N2. Return the same value
6558 returned by compare_ranges. Set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate
6559 whether we relied on an overflow infinity in the comparison. */
6563 compare_names (enum tree_code comp
, tree n1
, tree n2
,
6564 bool *strict_overflow_p
)
6568 bitmap_iterator bi1
, bi2
;
6570 int used_strict_overflow
;
6571 static bitmap_obstack
*s_obstack
= NULL
;
6572 static bitmap s_e1
= NULL
, s_e2
= NULL
;
6574 /* Compare the ranges of every name equivalent to N1 against the
6575 ranges of every name equivalent to N2. */
6576 e1
= get_value_range (n1
)->equiv
;
6577 e2
= get_value_range (n2
)->equiv
;
6579 /* Use the fake bitmaps if e1 or e2 are not available. */
6580 if (s_obstack
== NULL
)
6582 s_obstack
= XNEW (bitmap_obstack
);
6583 bitmap_obstack_initialize (s_obstack
);
6584 s_e1
= BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack
);
6585 s_e2
= BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack
);
6592 /* Add N1 and N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid
6593 duplicating the body of the loop just to check N1 and N2
6595 bitmap_set_bit (e1
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1
));
6596 bitmap_set_bit (e2
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2
));
6598 /* If the equivalence sets have a common intersection, then the two
6599 names can be compared without checking their ranges. */
6600 if (bitmap_intersect_p (e1
, e2
))
6602 bitmap_clear_bit (e1
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1
));
6603 bitmap_clear_bit (e2
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2
));
6605 return (comp
== EQ_EXPR
|| comp
== GE_EXPR
|| comp
== LE_EXPR
)
6607 : boolean_false_node
;
6610 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
6611 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
6612 used_strict_overflow
= -1;
6614 /* Otherwise, compare all the equivalent ranges. First, add N1 and
6615 N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid duplicating the body
6616 of the loop just to check N1 and N2 ranges. */
6617 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e1
, 0, i1
, bi1
)
6619 value_range_t vr1
= get_vr_for_comparison (i1
);
6621 t
= retval
= NULL_TREE
;
6622 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e2
, 0, i2
, bi2
)
6626 value_range_t vr2
= get_vr_for_comparison (i2
);
6628 t
= compare_ranges (comp
, &vr1
, &vr2
, &sop
);
6631 /* If we get different answers from different members
6632 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
6633 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
6634 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
6638 bitmap_clear_bit (e1
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1
));
6639 bitmap_clear_bit (e2
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2
));
6645 used_strict_overflow
= 0;
6646 else if (used_strict_overflow
< 0)
6647 used_strict_overflow
= 1;
6653 bitmap_clear_bit (e1
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1
));
6654 bitmap_clear_bit (e2
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2
));
6655 if (used_strict_overflow
> 0)
6656 *strict_overflow_p
= true;
6661 /* None of the equivalent ranges are useful in computing this
6663 bitmap_clear_bit (e1
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1
));
6664 bitmap_clear_bit (e2
, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2
));
6668 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv. */
6671 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges (enum tree_code code
,
6673 bool * strict_overflow_p
)
6675 value_range_t
*vr0
, *vr1
;
6677 vr0
= (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
) ? get_value_range (op0
) : NULL
;
6678 vr1
= (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
) ? get_value_range (op1
) : NULL
;
6681 return compare_ranges (code
, vr0
, vr1
, strict_overflow_p
);
6682 else if (vr0
&& vr1
== NULL
)
6683 return compare_range_with_value (code
, vr0
, op1
, strict_overflow_p
);
6684 else if (vr0
== NULL
&& vr1
)
6685 return (compare_range_with_value
6686 (swap_tree_comparison (code
), vr1
, op0
, strict_overflow_p
));
6690 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv. */
6693 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code code
, tree op0
,
6694 tree op1
, bool use_equiv_p
,
6695 bool *strict_overflow_p
, bool *only_ranges
)
6699 *only_ranges
= true;
6701 /* We only deal with integral and pointer types. */
6702 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0
))
6703 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0
)))
6709 && (ret
= vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges
6710 (code
, op0
, op1
, strict_overflow_p
)))
6712 *only_ranges
= false;
6713 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
&& TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
6714 return compare_names (code
, op0
, op1
, strict_overflow_p
);
6715 else if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
6716 return compare_name_with_value (code
, op0
, op1
, strict_overflow_p
);
6717 else if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
6718 return (compare_name_with_value
6719 (swap_tree_comparison (code
), op1
, op0
, strict_overflow_p
));
6722 return vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges (code
, op0
, op1
,
6727 /* Given (CODE OP0 OP1) within STMT, try to simplify it based on value range
6728 information. Return NULL if the conditional can not be evaluated.
6729 The ranges of all the names equivalent with the operands in COND
6730 will be used when trying to compute the value. If the result is
6731 based on undefined signed overflow, issue a warning if
6735 vrp_evaluate_conditional (enum tree_code code
, tree op0
, tree op1
, gimple stmt
)
6741 /* Some passes and foldings leak constants with overflow flag set
6742 into the IL. Avoid doing wrong things with these and bail out. */
6743 if ((TREE_CODE (op0
) == INTEGER_CST
6744 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op0
))
6745 || (TREE_CODE (op1
) == INTEGER_CST
6746 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op1
)))
6750 ret
= vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code
, op0
, op1
, true, &sop
,
6755 enum warn_strict_overflow_code wc
;
6756 const char* warnmsg
;
6758 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (ret
))
6760 wc
= WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_CONDITIONAL
;
6761 warnmsg
= G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
6762 "simplifying conditional to constant");
6766 wc
= WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_COMPARISON
;
6767 warnmsg
= G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
6768 "simplifying conditional");
6771 if (issue_strict_overflow_warning (wc
))
6773 location_t location
;
6775 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt
))
6776 location
= input_location
;
6778 location
= gimple_location (stmt
);
6779 warning_at (location
, OPT_Wstrict_overflow
, "%s", warnmsg
);
6783 if (warn_type_limits
6784 && ret
&& only_ranges
6785 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (code
) == tcc_comparison
6786 && TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
6788 /* If the comparison is being folded and the operand on the LHS
6789 is being compared against a constant value that is outside of
6790 the natural range of OP0's type, then the predicate will
6791 always fold regardless of the value of OP0. If -Wtype-limits
6792 was specified, emit a warning. */
6793 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (op0
);
6794 value_range_t
*vr0
= get_value_range (op0
);
6796 if (vr0
->type
!= VR_VARYING
6797 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type
)
6798 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0
->min
)
6799 && vrp_val_is_max (vr0
->max
)
6800 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1
))
6802 location_t location
;
6804 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt
))
6805 location
= input_location
;
6807 location
= gimple_location (stmt
);
6809 warning_at (location
, OPT_Wtype_limits
,
6811 ? G_("comparison always false "
6812 "due to limited range of data type")
6813 : G_("comparison always true "
6814 "due to limited range of data type"));
6822 /* Visit conditional statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
6823 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
6824 *TAKEN_EDGE_P and return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING. Otherwise, return
6825 SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
6827 static enum ssa_prop_result
6828 vrp_visit_cond_stmt (gimple stmt
, edge
*taken_edge_p
)
6833 *taken_edge_p
= NULL
;
6835 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6840 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nVisiting conditional with predicate: ");
6841 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
6842 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nWith known ranges\n");
6844 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (use
, stmt
, i
, SSA_OP_USE
)
6846 fprintf (dump_file
, "\t");
6847 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, use
, 0);
6848 fprintf (dump_file
, ": ");
6849 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr_value
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (use
)]);
6852 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
6855 /* Compute the value of the predicate COND by checking the known
6856 ranges of each of its operands.
6858 Note that we cannot evaluate all the equivalent ranges here
6859 because those ranges may not yet be final and with the current
6860 propagation strategy, we cannot determine when the value ranges
6861 of the names in the equivalence set have changed.
6863 For instance, given the following code fragment
6867 i_14 = ASSERT_EXPR <i_5, i_5 != 0>
6871 Assume that on the first visit to i_14, i_5 has the temporary
6872 range [8, 8] because the second argument to the PHI function is
6873 not yet executable. We derive the range ~[0, 0] for i_14 and the
6874 equivalence set { i_5 }. So, when we visit 'if (i_14 == 1)' for
6875 the first time, since i_14 is equivalent to the range [8, 8], we
6876 determine that the predicate is always false.
6878 On the next round of propagation, i_13 is determined to be
6879 VARYING, which causes i_5 to drop down to VARYING. So, another
6880 visit to i_14 is scheduled. In this second visit, we compute the
6881 exact same range and equivalence set for i_14, namely ~[0, 0] and
6882 { i_5 }. But we did not have the previous range for i_5
6883 registered, so vrp_visit_assignment thinks that the range for
6884 i_14 has not changed. Therefore, the predicate 'if (i_14 == 1)'
6885 is not visited again, which stops propagation from visiting
6886 statements in the THEN clause of that if().
6888 To properly fix this we would need to keep the previous range
6889 value for the names in the equivalence set. This way we would've
6890 discovered that from one visit to the other i_5 changed from
6891 range [8, 8] to VR_VARYING.
6893 However, fixing this apparent limitation may not be worth the
6894 additional checking. Testing on several code bases (GCC, DLV,
6895 MICO, TRAMP3D and SPEC2000) showed that doing this results in
6896 4 more predicates folded in SPEC. */
6899 val
= vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (gimple_cond_code (stmt
),
6900 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt
),
6901 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt
),
6906 *taken_edge_p
= find_taken_edge (gimple_bb (stmt
), val
);
6909 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6911 "\nIgnoring predicate evaluation because "
6912 "it assumes that signed overflow is undefined");
6917 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6919 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nPredicate evaluates to: ");
6920 if (val
== NULL_TREE
)
6921 fprintf (dump_file
, "DON'T KNOW\n");
6923 print_generic_stmt (dump_file
, val
, 0);
6926 return (*taken_edge_p
) ? SSA_PROP_INTERESTING
: SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
6929 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the index *IDX of the CASE_LABEL
6930 that includes the value VAL. The search is restricted to the range
6931 [START_IDX, n - 1] where n is the size of VEC.
6933 If there is a CASE_LABEL for VAL, its index is placed in IDX and true is
6936 If there is no CASE_LABEL for VAL and there is one that is larger than VAL,
6937 it is placed in IDX and false is returned.
6939 If VAL is larger than any CASE_LABEL, n is placed on IDX and false is
6943 find_case_label_index (gimple stmt
, size_t start_idx
, tree val
, size_t *idx
)
6945 size_t n
= gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt
);
6948 /* Find case label for minimum of the value range or the next one.
6949 At each iteration we are searching in [low, high - 1]. */
6951 for (low
= start_idx
, high
= n
; high
!= low
; )
6955 /* Note that i != high, so we never ask for n. */
6956 size_t i
= (high
+ low
) / 2;
6957 t
= gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
);
6959 /* Cache the result of comparing CASE_LOW and val. */
6960 cmp
= tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (t
), val
);
6964 /* Ranges cannot be empty. */
6973 if (CASE_HIGH (t
) != NULL
6974 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (t
), val
) >= 0)
6986 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the range of CASE_LABELs that is used
6987 for values between MIN and MAX. The first index is placed in MIN_IDX. The
6988 last index is placed in MAX_IDX. If the range of CASE_LABELs is empty
6989 then MAX_IDX < MIN_IDX.
6990 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
6993 find_case_label_range (gimple stmt
, tree min
, tree max
, size_t *min_idx
,
6997 bool min_take_default
= !find_case_label_index (stmt
, 1, min
, &i
);
6998 bool max_take_default
= !find_case_label_index (stmt
, i
, max
, &j
);
7002 && max_take_default
)
7004 /* Only the default case label reached.
7005 Return an empty range. */
7012 bool take_default
= min_take_default
|| max_take_default
;
7016 if (max_take_default
)
7019 /* If the case label range is continuous, we do not need
7020 the default case label. Verify that. */
7021 high
= CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
));
7022 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
)))
7023 high
= CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
));
7024 for (k
= i
+ 1; k
<= j
; ++k
)
7026 low
= CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, k
));
7027 if (!integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, low
, high
)))
7029 take_default
= true;
7033 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, k
)))
7034 high
= CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, k
));
7039 return !take_default
;
7043 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the ranges of CASE_LABELs that are
7044 used in range VR. The indices are placed in MIN_IDX1, MAX_IDX, MIN_IDX2 and
7045 MAX_IDX2. If the ranges of CASE_LABELs are empty then MAX_IDX1 < MIN_IDX1.
7046 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
7049 find_case_label_ranges (gimple stmt
, value_range_t
*vr
, size_t *min_idx1
,
7050 size_t *max_idx1
, size_t *min_idx2
,
7054 unsigned int n
= gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt
);
7056 tree case_low
, case_high
;
7057 tree min
= vr
->min
, max
= vr
->max
;
7059 gcc_checking_assert (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
|| vr
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
);
7061 take_default
= !find_case_label_range (stmt
, min
, max
, &i
, &j
);
7063 /* Set second range to emtpy. */
7067 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
)
7071 return !take_default
;
7074 /* Set first range to all case labels. */
7081 /* Make sure all the values of case labels [i , j] are contained in
7082 range [MIN, MAX]. */
7083 case_low
= CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
));
7084 case_high
= CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, j
));
7085 if (tree_int_cst_compare (case_low
, min
) < 0)
7087 if (case_high
!= NULL_TREE
7088 && tree_int_cst_compare (max
, case_high
) < 0)
7094 /* If the range spans case labels [i, j], the corresponding anti-range spans
7095 the labels [1, i - 1] and [j + 1, n - 1]. */
7121 /* Visit switch statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
7122 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
7123 *TAKEN_EDGE_P and return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING. Otherwise, return
7124 SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
7126 static enum ssa_prop_result
7127 vrp_visit_switch_stmt (gimple stmt
, edge
*taken_edge_p
)
7131 size_t i
= 0, j
= 0, k
, l
;
7134 *taken_edge_p
= NULL
;
7135 op
= gimple_switch_index (stmt
);
7136 if (TREE_CODE (op
) != SSA_NAME
)
7137 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7139 vr
= get_value_range (op
);
7140 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7142 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nVisiting switch expression with operand ");
7143 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, op
, 0);
7144 fprintf (dump_file
, " with known range ");
7145 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr
);
7146 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7149 if ((vr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
7150 && vr
->type
!= VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7151 || symbolic_range_p (vr
))
7152 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7154 /* Find the single edge that is taken from the switch expression. */
7155 take_default
= !find_case_label_ranges (stmt
, vr
, &i
, &j
, &k
, &l
);
7157 /* Check if the range spans no CASE_LABEL. If so, we only reach the default
7161 gcc_assert (take_default
);
7162 val
= gimple_switch_default_label (stmt
);
7166 /* Check if labels with index i to j and maybe the default label
7167 are all reaching the same label. */
7169 val
= gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
);
7171 && CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_default_label (stmt
))
7172 != CASE_LABEL (val
))
7174 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7175 fprintf (dump_file
, " not a single destination for this "
7177 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7179 for (++i
; i
<= j
; ++i
)
7181 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
)) != CASE_LABEL (val
))
7183 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7184 fprintf (dump_file
, " not a single destination for this "
7186 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7191 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt
, k
)) != CASE_LABEL (val
))
7193 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7194 fprintf (dump_file
, " not a single destination for this "
7196 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7201 *taken_edge_p
= find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt
),
7202 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (val
)));
7204 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7206 fprintf (dump_file
, " will take edge to ");
7207 print_generic_stmt (dump_file
, CASE_LABEL (val
), 0);
7210 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING
;
7214 /* Evaluate statement STMT. If the statement produces a useful range,
7215 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING and record the SSA name with the
7216 interesting range into *OUTPUT_P.
7218 If STMT is a conditional branch and we can determine its truth
7219 value, the taken edge is recorded in *TAKEN_EDGE_P.
7221 If STMT produces a varying value, return SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
7223 static enum ssa_prop_result
7224 vrp_visit_stmt (gimple stmt
, edge
*taken_edge_p
, tree
*output_p
)
7229 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7231 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nVisiting statement:\n");
7232 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, dump_flags
);
7233 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7236 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt
))
7237 gcc_assert (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt
));
7238 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
) || is_gimple_call (stmt
))
7240 /* In general, assignments with virtual operands are not useful
7241 for deriving ranges, with the obvious exception of calls to
7242 builtin functions. */
7243 if ((is_gimple_call (stmt
)
7244 && gimple_call_fndecl (stmt
) != NULL_TREE
7245 && DECL_BUILT_IN (gimple_call_fndecl (stmt
)))
7246 || !gimple_vuse (stmt
))
7247 return vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (stmt
, output_p
);
7249 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_COND
)
7250 return vrp_visit_cond_stmt (stmt
, taken_edge_p
);
7251 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
)
7252 return vrp_visit_switch_stmt (stmt
, taken_edge_p
);
7254 /* All other statements produce nothing of interest for VRP, so mark
7255 their outputs varying and prevent further simulation. */
7256 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def
, stmt
, iter
, SSA_OP_DEF
)
7257 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def
));
7259 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
7262 /* Union the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
7263 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
7264 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
7265 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
7268 union_ranges (enum value_range_type
*vr0type
,
7269 tree
*vr0min
, tree
*vr0max
,
7270 enum value_range_type vr1type
,
7271 tree vr1min
, tree vr1max
)
7273 bool mineq
= operand_equal_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
, 0);
7274 bool maxeq
= operand_equal_p (*vr0max
, vr1max
, 0);
7276 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
7280 if (*vr0type
== vr1type
)
7281 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
7283 else if ((*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7284 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7285 || (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7286 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
))
7288 /* For anti-range with range union the result is varying. */
7294 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1min
) == 1
7295 || operand_less_p (vr1max
, *vr0min
) == 1)
7297 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
7298 If the ranges have an empty intersection, result of the union
7299 operation is the anti-range or if both are anti-ranges
7301 if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7302 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7304 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7305 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7307 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7308 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7314 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7315 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7317 /* The result is the convex hull of both ranges. */
7318 if (operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1min
) == 1)
7320 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
7321 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
7322 && TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
7323 && vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min
)
7324 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max
))
7326 tree min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
,
7327 *vr0max
, integer_one_node
);
7328 tree max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
,
7329 vr1min
, integer_one_node
);
7330 if (!operand_less_p (max
, min
))
7332 *vr0type
= VR_ANTI_RANGE
;
7344 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
7345 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
7346 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
7347 && vrp_val_is_min (vr1min
)
7348 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max
))
7350 tree min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
,
7351 vr1max
, integer_one_node
);
7352 tree max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
,
7353 *vr0min
, integer_one_node
);
7354 if (!operand_less_p (max
, min
))
7356 *vr0type
= VR_ANTI_RANGE
;
7370 else if ((maxeq
|| operand_less_p (vr1max
, *vr0max
) == 1)
7371 && (mineq
|| operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
) == 1))
7373 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
7374 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7375 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7377 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7378 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7384 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7385 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7387 /* Arbitrarily choose the right or left gap. */
7388 if (!mineq
&& TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7389 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, vr1min
, integer_one_node
);
7390 else if (!maxeq
&& TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7391 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, vr1max
, integer_one_node
);
7395 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7396 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7397 /* The result covers everything. */
7402 else if ((maxeq
|| operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1max
) == 1)
7403 && (mineq
|| operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0min
) == 1))
7405 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
7406 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7407 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7413 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7414 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7416 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7417 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7419 *vr0type
= VR_ANTI_RANGE
;
7420 if (!mineq
&& TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7422 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, *vr0min
, integer_one_node
);
7425 else if (!maxeq
&& TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7427 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, *vr0max
, integer_one_node
);
7433 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7434 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7435 /* The result covers everything. */
7440 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0max
) == 1
7441 || operand_equal_p (vr1min
, *vr0max
, 0))
7442 && operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
) == 1)
7444 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
7445 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7446 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7448 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7449 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7451 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7452 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7454 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7455 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, vr1min
, integer_one_node
);
7459 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7460 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7462 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7465 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, *vr0max
, integer_one_node
);
7474 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1max
) == 1
7475 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min
, vr1max
, 0))
7476 && operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0min
) == 1)
7478 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
7479 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7480 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7482 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7483 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7485 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7486 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7488 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7489 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, vr1max
, integer_one_node
);
7493 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7494 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7496 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7500 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, *vr0min
, integer_one_node
);
7514 *vr0type
= VR_VARYING
;
7515 *vr0min
= NULL_TREE
;
7516 *vr0max
= NULL_TREE
;
7519 /* Intersect the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
7520 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
7521 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
7522 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
7525 intersect_ranges (enum value_range_type
*vr0type
,
7526 tree
*vr0min
, tree
*vr0max
,
7527 enum value_range_type vr1type
,
7528 tree vr1min
, tree vr1max
)
7530 bool mineq
= operand_equal_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
, 0);
7531 bool maxeq
= operand_equal_p (*vr0max
, vr1max
, 0);
7533 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
7537 if (*vr0type
== vr1type
)
7538 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
7540 else if ((*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7541 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7542 || (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7543 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
))
7545 /* For anti-range with range intersection the result is empty. */
7546 *vr0type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
7547 *vr0min
= NULL_TREE
;
7548 *vr0max
= NULL_TREE
;
7553 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1min
) == 1
7554 || operand_less_p (vr1max
, *vr0min
) == 1)
7556 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
7557 If the ranges have an empty intersection, the result of the
7558 intersect operation is the range for intersecting an
7559 anti-range with a range or empty when intersecting two ranges. */
7560 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7561 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7563 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7564 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7570 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7571 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7573 *vr0type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
7574 *vr0min
= NULL_TREE
;
7575 *vr0max
= NULL_TREE
;
7577 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7578 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7580 /* If the anti-ranges are adjacent to each other merge them. */
7581 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
7582 && TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
7583 && operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1min
) == 1
7584 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
,
7587 else if (TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
7588 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
7589 && operand_less_p (vr1max
, *vr0min
) == 1
7590 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
,
7593 /* Else arbitrarily take VR0. */
7596 else if ((maxeq
|| operand_less_p (vr1max
, *vr0max
) == 1)
7597 && (mineq
|| operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
) == 1))
7599 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
7600 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7601 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7603 /* If both are ranges the result is the inner one. */
7608 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7609 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7611 /* Choose the right gap if the left one is empty. */
7614 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7615 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, vr1max
, integer_one_node
);
7619 /* Choose the left gap if the right one is empty. */
7622 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7623 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, vr1min
,
7628 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
7629 else if (vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min
)
7630 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max
))
7636 /* Else choose the range. */
7638 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7639 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7640 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
7642 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7643 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7645 /* The intersection is empty. */
7646 *vr0type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
7647 *vr0min
= NULL_TREE
;
7648 *vr0max
= NULL_TREE
;
7653 else if ((maxeq
|| operand_less_p (*vr0max
, vr1max
) == 1)
7654 && (mineq
|| operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0min
) == 1))
7656 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
7657 if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7658 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7659 /* Choose the inner range. */
7661 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7662 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7664 /* Choose the right gap if the left is empty. */
7667 *vr0type
= VR_RANGE
;
7668 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7669 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, *vr0max
,
7675 /* Choose the left gap if the right is empty. */
7678 *vr0type
= VR_RANGE
;
7679 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7680 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, *vr0min
,
7686 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
7687 else if (vrp_val_is_min (vr1min
)
7688 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max
))
7690 /* Else choose the range. */
7698 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7699 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7701 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
7706 else if (vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7707 && *vr0type
== VR_RANGE
)
7709 /* The intersection is empty. */
7710 *vr0type
= VR_UNDEFINED
;
7711 *vr0min
= NULL_TREE
;
7712 *vr0max
= NULL_TREE
;
7717 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0max
) == 1
7718 || operand_equal_p (vr1min
, *vr0max
, 0))
7719 && operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1min
) == 1)
7721 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
7722 if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7723 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7725 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7726 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7728 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7729 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7731 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7732 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, vr1min
,
7737 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7738 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7740 *vr0type
= VR_RANGE
;
7741 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7742 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, *vr0max
,
7751 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min
, vr1max
) == 1
7752 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min
, vr1max
, 0))
7753 && operand_less_p (vr1min
, *vr0min
) == 1)
7755 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
7756 if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7757 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7759 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7760 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7762 else if (*vr0type
== VR_RANGE
7763 && vr1type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
7765 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7766 *vr0min
= int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR
, vr1max
,
7771 else if (*vr0type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7772 && vr1type
== VR_RANGE
)
7774 *vr0type
= VR_RANGE
;
7775 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min
) == INTEGER_CST
)
7776 *vr0max
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, *vr0min
,
7786 /* As a fallback simply use { *VRTYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } as
7787 result for the intersection. That's always a conservative
7788 correct estimate. */
7794 /* Intersect the two value-ranges *VR0 and *VR1 and store the result
7795 in *VR0. This may not be the smallest possible such range. */
7798 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
7800 value_range_t saved
;
7802 /* If either range is VR_VARYING the other one wins. */
7803 if (vr1
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7805 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7807 copy_value_range (vr0
, vr1
);
7811 /* When either range is VR_UNDEFINED the resulting range is
7812 VR_UNDEFINED, too. */
7813 if (vr0
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
7815 if (vr1
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
7817 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr0
);
7821 /* Save the original vr0 so we can return it as conservative intersection
7822 result when our worker turns things to varying. */
7824 intersect_ranges (&vr0
->type
, &vr0
->min
, &vr0
->max
,
7825 vr1
->type
, vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
);
7826 /* Make sure to canonicalize the result though as the inversion of a
7827 VR_RANGE can still be a VR_RANGE. */
7828 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0
, vr0
->type
,
7829 vr0
->min
, vr0
->max
, vr0
->equiv
);
7830 /* If that failed, use the saved original VR0. */
7831 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7836 /* If the result is VR_UNDEFINED there is no need to mess with
7837 the equivalencies. */
7838 if (vr0
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
7841 /* The resulting set of equivalences for range intersection is the union of
7843 if (vr0
->equiv
&& vr1
->equiv
&& vr0
->equiv
!= vr1
->equiv
)
7844 bitmap_ior_into (vr0
->equiv
, vr1
->equiv
);
7845 else if (vr1
->equiv
&& !vr0
->equiv
)
7846 bitmap_copy (vr0
->equiv
, vr1
->equiv
);
7850 vrp_intersect_ranges (value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
7852 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7854 fprintf (dump_file
, "Intersecting\n ");
7855 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr0
);
7856 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nand\n ");
7857 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr1
);
7858 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7860 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (vr0
, vr1
);
7861 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7863 fprintf (dump_file
, "to\n ");
7864 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr0
);
7865 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7869 /* Meet operation for value ranges. Given two value ranges VR0 and
7870 VR1, store in VR0 a range that contains both VR0 and VR1. This
7871 may not be the smallest possible such range. */
7874 vrp_meet_1 (value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
7876 value_range_t saved
;
7878 if (vr0
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
7880 /* Drop equivalences. See PR53465. */
7881 set_value_range (vr0
, vr1
->type
, vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
, NULL
);
7885 if (vr1
->type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
7887 /* VR0 already has the resulting range, just drop equivalences.
7890 bitmap_clear (vr0
->equiv
);
7894 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7896 /* Nothing to do. VR0 already has the resulting range. */
7900 if (vr1
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7902 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0
);
7907 union_ranges (&vr0
->type
, &vr0
->min
, &vr0
->max
,
7908 vr1
->type
, vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
);
7909 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7911 /* Failed to find an efficient meet. Before giving up and setting
7912 the result to VARYING, see if we can at least derive a useful
7913 anti-range. FIXME, all this nonsense about distinguishing
7914 anti-ranges from ranges is necessary because of the odd
7915 semantics of range_includes_zero_p and friends. */
7916 if (((saved
.type
== VR_RANGE
7917 && range_includes_zero_p (saved
.min
, saved
.max
) == 0)
7918 || (saved
.type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7919 && range_includes_zero_p (saved
.min
, saved
.max
) == 1))
7920 && ((vr1
->type
== VR_RANGE
7921 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
) == 0)
7922 || (vr1
->type
== VR_ANTI_RANGE
7923 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1
->min
, vr1
->max
) == 1)))
7925 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr0
, TREE_TYPE (saved
.min
));
7927 /* Since this meet operation did not result from the meeting of
7928 two equivalent names, VR0 cannot have any equivalences. */
7930 bitmap_clear (vr0
->equiv
);
7934 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0
);
7937 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0
, vr0
->type
, vr0
->min
, vr0
->max
,
7939 if (vr0
->type
== VR_VARYING
)
7942 /* The resulting set of equivalences is always the intersection of
7944 if (vr0
->equiv
&& vr1
->equiv
&& vr0
->equiv
!= vr1
->equiv
)
7945 bitmap_and_into (vr0
->equiv
, vr1
->equiv
);
7946 else if (vr0
->equiv
&& !vr1
->equiv
)
7947 bitmap_clear (vr0
->equiv
);
7951 vrp_meet (value_range_t
*vr0
, value_range_t
*vr1
)
7953 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7955 fprintf (dump_file
, "Meeting\n ");
7956 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr0
);
7957 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nand\n ");
7958 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr1
);
7959 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7961 vrp_meet_1 (vr0
, vr1
);
7962 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7964 fprintf (dump_file
, "to\n ");
7965 dump_value_range (dump_file
, vr0
);
7966 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7971 /* Visit all arguments for PHI node PHI that flow through executable
7972 edges. If a valid value range can be derived from all the incoming
7973 value ranges, set a new range for the LHS of PHI. */
7975 static enum ssa_prop_result
7976 vrp_visit_phi_node (gimple phi
)
7979 tree lhs
= PHI_RESULT (phi
);
7980 value_range_t
*lhs_vr
= get_value_range (lhs
);
7981 value_range_t vr_result
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
7983 int edges
, old_edges
;
7986 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7988 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nVisiting PHI node: ");
7989 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, phi
, 0, dump_flags
);
7993 for (i
= 0; i
< gimple_phi_num_args (phi
); i
++)
7995 edge e
= gimple_phi_arg_edge (phi
, i
);
7997 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
8000 "\n Argument #%d (%d -> %d %sexecutable)\n",
8001 (int) i
, e
->src
->index
, e
->dest
->index
,
8002 (e
->flags
& EDGE_EXECUTABLE
) ? "" : "not ");
8005 if (e
->flags
& EDGE_EXECUTABLE
)
8007 tree arg
= PHI_ARG_DEF (phi
, i
);
8008 value_range_t vr_arg
;
8012 if (TREE_CODE (arg
) == SSA_NAME
)
8014 vr_arg
= *(get_value_range (arg
));
8018 if (is_overflow_infinity (arg
))
8020 arg
= copy_node (arg
);
8021 TREE_OVERFLOW (arg
) = 0;
8024 vr_arg
.type
= VR_RANGE
;
8027 vr_arg
.equiv
= NULL
;
8030 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
8032 fprintf (dump_file
, "\t");
8033 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, arg
, dump_flags
);
8034 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n\tValue: ");
8035 dump_value_range (dump_file
, &vr_arg
);
8036 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
8040 copy_value_range (&vr_result
, &vr_arg
);
8042 vrp_meet (&vr_result
, &vr_arg
);
8045 if (vr_result
.type
== VR_VARYING
)
8050 if (vr_result
.type
== VR_VARYING
)
8052 else if (vr_result
.type
== VR_UNDEFINED
)
8055 old_edges
= vr_phi_edge_counts
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs
)];
8056 vr_phi_edge_counts
[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs
)] = edges
;
8058 /* To prevent infinite iterations in the algorithm, derive ranges
8059 when the new value is slightly bigger or smaller than the
8060 previous one. We don't do this if we have seen a new executable
8061 edge; this helps us avoid an overflow infinity for conditionals
8062 which are not in a loop. If the old value-range was VR_UNDEFINED
8063 use the updated range and iterate one more time. */
8065 && gimple_phi_num_args (phi
) > 1
8066 && edges
== old_edges
8067 && lhs_vr
->type
!= VR_UNDEFINED
)
8069 int cmp_min
= compare_values (lhs_vr
->min
, vr_result
.min
);
8070 int cmp_max
= compare_values (lhs_vr
->max
, vr_result
.max
);
8072 /* For non VR_RANGE or for pointers fall back to varying if
8073 the range changed. */
8074 if ((lhs_vr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
|| vr_result
.type
!= VR_RANGE
8075 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs
)))
8076 && (cmp_min
!= 0 || cmp_max
!= 0))
8079 /* If the new minimum is smaller or larger than the previous
8080 one, go all the way to -INF. In the first case, to avoid
8081 iterating millions of times to reach -INF, and in the
8082 other case to avoid infinite bouncing between different
8084 if (cmp_min
> 0 || cmp_min
< 0)
8086 if (!needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.min
))
8087 || !vrp_var_may_overflow (lhs
, phi
))
8088 vr_result
.min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.min
));
8089 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.min
)))
8091 negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.min
));
8094 /* Similarly, if the new maximum is smaller or larger than
8095 the previous one, go all the way to +INF. */
8096 if (cmp_max
< 0 || cmp_max
> 0)
8098 if (!needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.max
))
8099 || !vrp_var_may_overflow (lhs
, phi
))
8100 vr_result
.max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.max
));
8101 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.max
)))
8103 positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result
.max
));
8106 /* If we dropped either bound to +-INF then if this is a loop
8107 PHI node SCEV may known more about its value-range. */
8108 if ((cmp_min
> 0 || cmp_min
< 0
8109 || cmp_max
< 0 || cmp_max
> 0)
8111 && (l
= loop_containing_stmt (phi
))
8112 && l
->header
== gimple_bb (phi
))
8113 adjust_range_with_scev (&vr_result
, l
, phi
, lhs
);
8115 /* If we will end up with a (-INF, +INF) range, set it to
8116 VARYING. Same if the previous max value was invalid for
8117 the type and we end up with vr_result.min > vr_result.max. */
8118 if ((vrp_val_is_max (vr_result
.max
)
8119 && vrp_val_is_min (vr_result
.min
))
8120 || compare_values (vr_result
.min
,
8125 /* If the new range is different than the previous value, keep
8128 if (update_value_range (lhs
, &vr_result
))
8130 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
8132 fprintf (dump_file
, "Found new range for ");
8133 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, lhs
, 0);
8134 fprintf (dump_file
, ": ");
8135 dump_value_range (dump_file
, &vr_result
);
8136 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n\n");
8139 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING
;
8142 /* Nothing changed, don't add outgoing edges. */
8143 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING
;
8145 /* No match found. Set the LHS to VARYING. */
8147 set_value_range_to_varying (lhs_vr
);
8148 return SSA_PROP_VARYING
;
8151 /* Simplify boolean operations if the source is known
8152 to be already a boolean. */
8154 simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator
*gsi
, gimple stmt
)
8156 enum tree_code rhs_code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
8158 bool need_conversion
;
8160 /* We handle only !=/== case here. */
8161 gcc_assert (rhs_code
== EQ_EXPR
|| rhs_code
== NE_EXPR
);
8163 op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8164 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op0
))
8167 op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
);
8168 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op1
))
8171 /* Reduce number of cases to handle to NE_EXPR. As there is no
8172 BIT_XNOR_EXPR we cannot replace A == B with a single statement. */
8173 if (rhs_code
== EQ_EXPR
)
8175 if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == INTEGER_CST
)
8176 op1
= int_const_binop (BIT_XOR_EXPR
, op1
, integer_one_node
);
8181 lhs
= gimple_assign_lhs (stmt
);
8183 = !useless_type_conversion_p (TREE_TYPE (lhs
), TREE_TYPE (op0
));
8185 /* Make sure to not sign-extend a 1-bit 1 when converting the result. */
8187 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0
))
8188 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op0
)) == 1
8189 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (lhs
)) > 1)
8192 /* For A != 0 we can substitute A itself. */
8193 if (integer_zerop (op1
))
8194 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi
,
8196 ? NOP_EXPR
: TREE_CODE (op0
),
8198 /* For A != B we substitute A ^ B. Either with conversion. */
8199 else if (need_conversion
)
8201 tree tem
= make_ssa_name (TREE_TYPE (op0
), NULL
);
8202 gimple newop
= gimple_build_assign_with_ops (BIT_XOR_EXPR
, tem
, op0
, op1
);
8203 gsi_insert_before (gsi
, newop
, GSI_SAME_STMT
);
8204 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi
, NOP_EXPR
, tem
, NULL_TREE
);
8208 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi
, BIT_XOR_EXPR
, op0
, op1
);
8209 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi
));
8214 /* Simplify a division or modulo operator to a right shift or
8215 bitwise and if the first operand is unsigned or is greater
8216 than zero and the second operand is an exact power of two. */
8219 simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (gimple stmt
)
8221 enum tree_code rhs_code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
8223 tree op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8224 tree op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
);
8225 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
));
8227 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0
)))
8229 val
= integer_one_node
;
8235 val
= compare_range_with_value (GE_EXPR
, vr
, integer_zero_node
, &sop
);
8239 && integer_onep (val
)
8240 && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC
))
8242 location_t location
;
8244 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt
))
8245 location
= input_location
;
8247 location
= gimple_location (stmt
);
8248 warning_at (location
, OPT_Wstrict_overflow
,
8249 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
8250 "simplifying %</%> or %<%%%> to %<>>%> or %<&%>");
8254 if (val
&& integer_onep (val
))
8258 if (rhs_code
== TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
)
8260 t
= build_int_cst (integer_type_node
, tree_log2 (op1
));
8261 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt
, RSHIFT_EXPR
);
8262 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt
, op0
);
8263 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt
, t
);
8267 t
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op1
), 1);
8268 t
= int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR
, op1
, t
);
8269 t
= fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op0
), t
);
8271 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt
, BIT_AND_EXPR
);
8272 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt
, op0
);
8273 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt
, t
);
8283 /* If the operand to an ABS_EXPR is >= 0, then eliminate the
8284 ABS_EXPR. If the operand is <= 0, then simplify the
8285 ABS_EXPR into a NEGATE_EXPR. */
8288 simplify_abs_using_ranges (gimple stmt
)
8291 tree op
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8292 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (op
);
8293 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (op
);
8295 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
))
8297 val
= integer_zero_node
;
8303 val
= compare_range_with_value (LE_EXPR
, vr
, integer_zero_node
, &sop
);
8307 val
= compare_range_with_value (GE_EXPR
, vr
, integer_zero_node
,
8312 if (integer_zerop (val
))
8313 val
= integer_one_node
;
8314 else if (integer_onep (val
))
8315 val
= integer_zero_node
;
8320 && (integer_onep (val
) || integer_zerop (val
)))
8322 if (sop
&& issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC
))
8324 location_t location
;
8326 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt
))
8327 location
= input_location
;
8329 location
= gimple_location (stmt
);
8330 warning_at (location
, OPT_Wstrict_overflow
,
8331 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
8332 "simplifying %<abs (X)%> to %<X%> or %<-X%>");
8335 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt
, op
);
8336 if (integer_onep (val
))
8337 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt
, NEGATE_EXPR
);
8339 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt
, SSA_NAME
);
8348 /* Optimize away redundant BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR.
8349 If all the bits that are being cleared by & are already
8350 known to be zero from VR, or all the bits that are being
8351 set by | are already known to be one from VR, the bit
8352 operation is redundant. */
8355 simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator
*gsi
, gimple stmt
)
8357 tree op0
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8358 tree op1
= gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
);
8359 tree op
= NULL_TREE
;
8360 value_range_t vr0
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
8361 value_range_t vr1
= VR_INITIALIZER
;
8362 double_int may_be_nonzero0
, may_be_nonzero1
;
8363 double_int must_be_nonzero0
, must_be_nonzero1
;
8366 if (TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
)
8367 vr0
= *(get_value_range (op0
));
8368 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0
))
8369 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0
, op0
, NULL
);
8373 if (TREE_CODE (op1
) == SSA_NAME
)
8374 vr1
= *(get_value_range (op1
));
8375 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1
))
8376 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1
, op1
, NULL
);
8380 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr0
, &may_be_nonzero0
, &must_be_nonzero0
))
8382 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr1
, &may_be_nonzero1
, &must_be_nonzero1
))
8385 switch (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
))
8388 mask
= may_be_nonzero0
.and_not (must_be_nonzero1
);
8389 if (mask
.is_zero ())
8394 mask
= may_be_nonzero1
.and_not (must_be_nonzero0
);
8395 if (mask
.is_zero ())
8402 mask
= may_be_nonzero0
.and_not (must_be_nonzero1
);
8403 if (mask
.is_zero ())
8408 mask
= may_be_nonzero1
.and_not (must_be_nonzero0
);
8409 if (mask
.is_zero ())
8419 if (op
== NULL_TREE
)
8422 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi
, TREE_CODE (op
), op
, NULL
);
8423 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi
));
8427 /* We are comparing trees OP0 and OP1 using COND_CODE. OP0 has
8428 a known value range VR.
8430 If there is one and only one value which will satisfy the
8431 conditional, then return that value. Else return NULL. */
8434 test_for_singularity (enum tree_code cond_code
, tree op0
,
8435 tree op1
, value_range_t
*vr
)
8440 /* Extract minimum/maximum values which satisfy the
8441 the conditional as it was written. */
8442 if (cond_code
== LE_EXPR
|| cond_code
== LT_EXPR
)
8444 /* This should not be negative infinity; there is no overflow
8446 min
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0
));
8449 if (cond_code
== LT_EXPR
&& !is_overflow_infinity (max
))
8451 tree one
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0
), 1);
8452 max
= fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (op0
), max
, one
);
8454 TREE_NO_WARNING (max
) = 1;
8457 else if (cond_code
== GE_EXPR
|| cond_code
== GT_EXPR
)
8459 /* This should not be positive infinity; there is no overflow
8461 max
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0
));
8464 if (cond_code
== GT_EXPR
&& !is_overflow_infinity (min
))
8466 tree one
= build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0
), 1);
8467 min
= fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (op0
), min
, one
);
8469 TREE_NO_WARNING (min
) = 1;
8473 /* Now refine the minimum and maximum values using any
8474 value range information we have for op0. */
8477 if (compare_values (vr
->min
, min
) == 1)
8479 if (compare_values (vr
->max
, max
) == -1)
8482 /* If the new min/max values have converged to a single value,
8483 then there is only one value which can satisfy the condition,
8484 return that value. */
8485 if (operand_equal_p (min
, max
, 0) && is_gimple_min_invariant (min
))
8491 /* Simplify a conditional using a relational operator to an equality
8492 test if the range information indicates only one value can satisfy
8493 the original conditional. */
8496 simplify_cond_using_ranges (gimple stmt
)
8498 tree op0
= gimple_cond_lhs (stmt
);
8499 tree op1
= gimple_cond_rhs (stmt
);
8500 enum tree_code cond_code
= gimple_cond_code (stmt
);
8502 if (cond_code
!= NE_EXPR
8503 && cond_code
!= EQ_EXPR
8504 && TREE_CODE (op0
) == SSA_NAME
8505 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0
))
8506 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1
))
8508 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (op0
);
8510 /* If we have range information for OP0, then we might be
8511 able to simplify this conditional. */
8512 if (vr
->type
== VR_RANGE
)
8514 tree new_tree
= test_for_singularity (cond_code
, op0
, op1
, vr
);
8520 fprintf (dump_file
, "Simplified relational ");
8521 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
8522 fprintf (dump_file
, " into ");
8525 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt
, EQ_EXPR
);
8526 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt
, op0
);
8527 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt
, new_tree
);
8533 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
8534 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
8540 /* Try again after inverting the condition. We only deal
8541 with integral types here, so no need to worry about
8542 issues with inverting FP comparisons. */
8543 cond_code
= invert_tree_comparison (cond_code
, false);
8544 new_tree
= test_for_singularity (cond_code
, op0
, op1
, vr
);
8550 fprintf (dump_file
, "Simplified relational ");
8551 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
8552 fprintf (dump_file
, " into ");
8555 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt
, NE_EXPR
);
8556 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt
, op0
);
8557 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt
, new_tree
);
8563 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
8564 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
8575 /* Simplify a switch statement using the value range of the switch
8579 simplify_switch_using_ranges (gimple stmt
)
8581 tree op
= gimple_switch_index (stmt
);
8586 size_t i
= 0, j
= 0, n
, n2
;
8589 size_t k
= 1, l
= 0;
8591 if (TREE_CODE (op
) == SSA_NAME
)
8593 vr
= get_value_range (op
);
8595 /* We can only handle integer ranges. */
8596 if ((vr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
8597 && vr
->type
!= VR_ANTI_RANGE
)
8598 || symbolic_range_p (vr
))
8601 /* Find case label for min/max of the value range. */
8602 take_default
= !find_case_label_ranges (stmt
, vr
, &i
, &j
, &k
, &l
);
8604 else if (TREE_CODE (op
) == INTEGER_CST
)
8606 take_default
= !find_case_label_index (stmt
, 1, op
, &i
);
8620 n
= gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt
);
8622 /* Bail out if this is just all edges taken. */
8628 /* Build a new vector of taken case labels. */
8629 vec2
= make_tree_vec (j
- i
+ 1 + l
- k
+ 1 + (int)take_default
);
8632 /* Add the default edge, if necessary. */
8634 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2
, n2
++) = gimple_switch_default_label (stmt
);
8636 for (; i
<= j
; ++i
, ++n2
)
8637 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2
, n2
) = gimple_switch_label (stmt
, i
);
8639 for (; k
<= l
; ++k
, ++n2
)
8640 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2
, n2
) = gimple_switch_label (stmt
, k
);
8642 /* Mark needed edges. */
8643 for (i
= 0; i
< n2
; ++i
)
8645 e
= find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt
),
8646 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2
, i
))));
8647 e
->aux
= (void *)-1;
8650 /* Queue not needed edges for later removal. */
8651 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, gimple_bb (stmt
)->succs
)
8653 if (e
->aux
== (void *)-1)
8659 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
8661 fprintf (dump_file
, "removing unreachable case label\n");
8663 to_remove_edges
.safe_push (e
);
8664 e
->flags
&= ~EDGE_EXECUTABLE
;
8667 /* And queue an update for the stmt. */
8670 to_update_switch_stmts
.safe_push (su
);
8674 /* Simplify an integral conversion from an SSA name in STMT. */
8677 simplify_conversion_using_ranges (gimple stmt
)
8679 tree innerop
, middleop
, finaltype
;
8681 value_range_t
*innervr
;
8682 bool inner_unsigned_p
, middle_unsigned_p
, final_unsigned_p
;
8683 unsigned inner_prec
, middle_prec
, final_prec
;
8684 double_int innermin
, innermed
, innermax
, middlemin
, middlemed
, middlemax
;
8686 finaltype
= TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt
));
8687 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (finaltype
))
8689 middleop
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8690 def_stmt
= SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (middleop
);
8691 if (!is_gimple_assign (def_stmt
)
8692 || !CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt
)))
8694 innerop
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt
);
8695 if (TREE_CODE (innerop
) != SSA_NAME
)
8698 /* Get the value-range of the inner operand. */
8699 innervr
= get_value_range (innerop
);
8700 if (innervr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
8701 || TREE_CODE (innervr
->min
) != INTEGER_CST
8702 || TREE_CODE (innervr
->max
) != INTEGER_CST
)
8705 /* Simulate the conversion chain to check if the result is equal if
8706 the middle conversion is removed. */
8707 innermin
= tree_to_double_int (innervr
->min
);
8708 innermax
= tree_to_double_int (innervr
->max
);
8710 inner_prec
= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (innerop
));
8711 middle_prec
= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (middleop
));
8712 final_prec
= TYPE_PRECISION (finaltype
);
8714 /* If the first conversion is not injective, the second must not
8716 if ((innermax
- innermin
).ugt (double_int::mask (middle_prec
))
8717 && middle_prec
< final_prec
)
8719 /* We also want a medium value so that we can track the effect that
8720 narrowing conversions with sign change have. */
8721 inner_unsigned_p
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (innerop
));
8722 if (inner_unsigned_p
)
8723 innermed
= double_int::mask (inner_prec
).lrshift (1, inner_prec
);
8725 innermed
= double_int_zero
;
8726 if (innermin
.cmp (innermed
, inner_unsigned_p
) >= 0
8727 || innermed
.cmp (innermax
, inner_unsigned_p
) >= 0)
8728 innermed
= innermin
;
8730 middle_unsigned_p
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (middleop
));
8731 middlemin
= innermin
.ext (middle_prec
, middle_unsigned_p
);
8732 middlemed
= innermed
.ext (middle_prec
, middle_unsigned_p
);
8733 middlemax
= innermax
.ext (middle_prec
, middle_unsigned_p
);
8735 /* Require that the final conversion applied to both the original
8736 and the intermediate range produces the same result. */
8737 final_unsigned_p
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (finaltype
);
8738 if (middlemin
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
)
8739 != innermin
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
)
8740 || middlemed
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
)
8741 != innermed
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
)
8742 || middlemax
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
)
8743 != innermax
.ext (final_prec
, final_unsigned_p
))
8746 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt
, innerop
);
8751 /* Return whether the value range *VR fits in an integer type specified
8752 by PRECISION and UNSIGNED_P. */
8755 range_fits_type_p (value_range_t
*vr
, unsigned precision
, bool unsigned_p
)
8758 unsigned src_precision
;
8761 /* We can only handle integral and pointer types. */
8762 src_type
= TREE_TYPE (vr
->min
);
8763 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (src_type
)
8764 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (src_type
))
8767 /* An extension is fine unless VR is signed and unsigned_p,
8768 and so is an identity transform. */
8769 src_precision
= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (vr
->min
));
8770 if ((src_precision
< precision
8771 && !(unsigned_p
&& !TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type
)))
8772 || (src_precision
== precision
8773 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type
) == unsigned_p
))
8776 /* Now we can only handle ranges with constant bounds. */
8777 if (vr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
8778 || TREE_CODE (vr
->min
) != INTEGER_CST
8779 || TREE_CODE (vr
->max
) != INTEGER_CST
)
8782 /* For sign changes, the MSB of the double_int has to be clear.
8783 An unsigned value with its MSB set cannot be represented by
8784 a signed double_int, while a negative value cannot be represented
8785 by an unsigned double_int. */
8786 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type
) != unsigned_p
8787 && (TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (vr
->min
) | TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (vr
->max
)) < 0)
8790 /* Then we can perform the conversion on both ends and compare
8791 the result for equality. */
8792 tem
= tree_to_double_int (vr
->min
).ext (precision
, unsigned_p
);
8793 if (tree_to_double_int (vr
->min
) != tem
)
8795 tem
= tree_to_double_int (vr
->max
).ext (precision
, unsigned_p
);
8796 if (tree_to_double_int (vr
->max
) != tem
)
8802 /* Simplify a conversion from integral SSA name to float in STMT. */
8805 simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator
*gsi
, gimple stmt
)
8807 tree rhs1
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8808 value_range_t
*vr
= get_value_range (rhs1
);
8809 enum machine_mode fltmode
= TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt
)));
8810 enum machine_mode mode
;
8814 /* We can only handle constant ranges. */
8815 if (vr
->type
!= VR_RANGE
8816 || TREE_CODE (vr
->min
) != INTEGER_CST
8817 || TREE_CODE (vr
->max
) != INTEGER_CST
)
8820 /* First check if we can use a signed type in place of an unsigned. */
8821 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
))
8822 && (can_float_p (fltmode
, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)), 0)
8823 != CODE_FOR_nothing
)
8824 && range_fits_type_p (vr
, GET_MODE_PRECISION
8825 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
))), 0))
8826 mode
= TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
));
8827 /* If we can do the conversion in the current input mode do nothing. */
8828 else if (can_float_p (fltmode
, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)),
8829 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
))) != CODE_FOR_nothing
)
8831 /* Otherwise search for a mode we can use, starting from the narrowest
8832 integer mode available. */
8835 mode
= GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT
);
8838 /* If we cannot do a signed conversion to float from mode
8839 or if the value-range does not fit in the signed type
8840 try with a wider mode. */
8841 if (can_float_p (fltmode
, mode
, 0) != CODE_FOR_nothing
8842 && range_fits_type_p (vr
, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode
), 0))
8845 mode
= GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode
);
8846 /* But do not widen the input. Instead leave that to the
8847 optabs expansion code. */
8848 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode
) > TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8851 while (mode
!= VOIDmode
);
8852 if (mode
== VOIDmode
)
8856 /* It works, insert a truncation or sign-change before the
8857 float conversion. */
8858 tem
= make_ssa_name (build_nonstandard_integer_type
8859 (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode
), 0), NULL
);
8860 conv
= gimple_build_assign_with_ops (NOP_EXPR
, tem
, rhs1
, NULL_TREE
);
8861 gsi_insert_before (gsi
, conv
, GSI_SAME_STMT
);
8862 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt
, tem
);
8868 /* Simplify STMT using ranges if possible. */
8871 simplify_stmt_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator
*gsi
)
8873 gimple stmt
= gsi_stmt (*gsi
);
8874 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
))
8876 enum tree_code rhs_code
= gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
);
8877 tree rhs1
= gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
);
8883 /* Transform EQ_EXPR, NE_EXPR into BIT_XOR_EXPR or identity
8884 if the RHS is zero or one, and the LHS are known to be boolean
8886 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8887 return simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gsi
, stmt
);
8890 /* Transform TRUNC_DIV_EXPR and TRUNC_MOD_EXPR into RSHIFT_EXPR
8891 and BIT_AND_EXPR respectively if the first operand is greater
8892 than zero and the second operand is an exact power of two. */
8893 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
:
8894 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
:
8895 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
))
8896 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
)))
8897 return simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (stmt
);
8900 /* Transform ABS (X) into X or -X as appropriate. */
8902 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1
) == SSA_NAME
8903 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8904 return simplify_abs_using_ranges (stmt
);
8909 /* Optimize away BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR
8910 if all the bits being cleared are already cleared or
8911 all the bits being set are already set. */
8912 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8913 return simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gsi
, stmt
);
8917 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1
) == SSA_NAME
8918 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8919 return simplify_conversion_using_ranges (stmt
);
8923 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1
) == SSA_NAME
8924 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1
)))
8925 return simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gsi
, stmt
);
8932 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_COND
)
8933 return simplify_cond_using_ranges (stmt
);
8934 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
)
8935 return simplify_switch_using_ranges (stmt
);
8940 /* If the statement pointed by SI has a predicate whose value can be
8941 computed using the value range information computed by VRP, compute
8942 its value and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
8945 fold_predicate_in (gimple_stmt_iterator
*si
)
8947 bool assignment_p
= false;
8949 gimple stmt
= gsi_stmt (*si
);
8951 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
)
8952 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
)) == tcc_comparison
)
8954 assignment_p
= true;
8955 val
= vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt
),
8956 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt
),
8957 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt
),
8960 else if (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_COND
)
8961 val
= vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (stmt
),
8962 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt
),
8963 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt
),
8971 val
= fold_convert (gimple_expr_type (stmt
), val
);
8975 fprintf (dump_file
, "Folding predicate ");
8976 print_gimple_expr (dump_file
, stmt
, 0, 0);
8977 fprintf (dump_file
, " to ");
8978 print_generic_expr (dump_file
, val
, 0);
8979 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
8982 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt
))
8983 gimple_assign_set_rhs_from_tree (si
, val
);
8986 gcc_assert (gimple_code (stmt
) == GIMPLE_COND
);
8987 if (integer_zerop (val
))
8988 gimple_cond_make_false (stmt
);
8989 else if (integer_onep (val
))
8990 gimple_cond_make_true (stmt
);
9001 /* Callback for substitute_and_fold folding the stmt at *SI. */
9004 vrp_fold_stmt (gimple_stmt_iterator
*si
)
9006 if (fold_predicate_in (si
))
9009 return simplify_stmt_using_ranges (si
);
9012 /* Stack of dest,src equivalency pairs that need to be restored after
9013 each attempt to thread a block's incoming edge to an outgoing edge.
9015 A NULL entry is used to mark the end of pairs which need to be
9017 static vec
<tree
> equiv_stack
;
9019 /* A trivial wrapper so that we can present the generic jump threading
9020 code with a simple API for simplifying statements. STMT is the
9021 statement we want to simplify, WITHIN_STMT provides the location
9022 for any overflow warnings. */
9025 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading (gimple stmt
, gimple within_stmt
)
9027 /* We only use VRP information to simplify conditionals. This is
9028 overly conservative, but it's unclear if doing more would be
9029 worth the compile time cost. */
9030 if (gimple_code (stmt
) != GIMPLE_COND
)
9033 return vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (stmt
),
9034 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt
),
9035 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt
), within_stmt
);
9038 /* Blocks which have more than one predecessor and more than
9039 one successor present jump threading opportunities, i.e.,
9040 when the block is reached from a specific predecessor, we
9041 may be able to determine which of the outgoing edges will
9042 be traversed. When this optimization applies, we are able
9043 to avoid conditionals at runtime and we may expose secondary
9044 optimization opportunities.
9046 This routine is effectively a driver for the generic jump
9047 threading code. It basically just presents the generic code
9048 with edges that may be suitable for jump threading.
9050 Unlike DOM, we do not iterate VRP if jump threading was successful.
9051 While iterating may expose new opportunities for VRP, it is expected
9052 those opportunities would be very limited and the compile time cost
9053 to expose those opportunities would be significant.
9055 As jump threading opportunities are discovered, they are registered
9056 for later realization. */
9059 identify_jump_threads (void)
9066 /* Ugh. When substituting values earlier in this pass we can
9067 wipe the dominance information. So rebuild the dominator
9068 information as we need it within the jump threading code. */
9069 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS
);
9071 /* We do not allow VRP information to be used for jump threading
9072 across a back edge in the CFG. Otherwise it becomes too
9073 difficult to avoid eliminating loop exit tests. Of course
9074 EDGE_DFS_BACK is not accurate at this time so we have to
9076 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
9078 /* Do not thread across edges we are about to remove. Just marking
9079 them as EDGE_DFS_BACK will do. */
9080 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges
, i
, e
)
9081 e
->flags
|= EDGE_DFS_BACK
;
9083 /* Allocate our unwinder stack to unwind any temporary equivalences
9084 that might be recorded. */
9085 equiv_stack
.create (20);
9087 /* To avoid lots of silly node creation, we create a single
9088 conditional and just modify it in-place when attempting to
9090 dummy
= gimple_build_cond (EQ_EXPR
,
9091 integer_zero_node
, integer_zero_node
,
9094 /* Walk through all the blocks finding those which present a
9095 potential jump threading opportunity. We could set this up
9096 as a dominator walker and record data during the walk, but
9097 I doubt it's worth the effort for the classes of jump
9098 threading opportunities we are trying to identify at this
9099 point in compilation. */
9104 /* If the generic jump threading code does not find this block
9105 interesting, then there is nothing to do. */
9106 if (! potentially_threadable_block (bb
))
9109 /* We only care about blocks ending in a COND_EXPR. While there
9110 may be some value in handling SWITCH_EXPR here, I doubt it's
9111 terribly important. */
9112 last
= gsi_stmt (gsi_last_bb (bb
));
9114 /* We're basically looking for a switch or any kind of conditional with
9115 integral or pointer type arguments. Note the type of the second
9116 argument will be the same as the first argument, so no need to
9117 check it explicitly. */
9118 if (gimple_code (last
) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
9119 || (gimple_code (last
) == GIMPLE_COND
9120 && TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_lhs (last
)) == SSA_NAME
9121 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last
)))
9122 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last
))))
9123 && (TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_rhs (last
)) == SSA_NAME
9124 || is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_cond_rhs (last
)))))
9128 /* We've got a block with multiple predecessors and multiple
9129 successors which also ends in a suitable conditional or
9130 switch statement. For each predecessor, see if we can thread
9131 it to a specific successor. */
9132 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
9134 /* Do not thread across back edges or abnormal edges
9136 if (e
->flags
& (EDGE_DFS_BACK
| EDGE_COMPLEX
))
9139 thread_across_edge (dummy
, e
, true, &equiv_stack
,
9140 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading
);
9145 /* We do not actually update the CFG or SSA graphs at this point as
9146 ASSERT_EXPRs are still in the IL and cfg cleanup code does not yet
9147 handle ASSERT_EXPRs gracefully. */
9150 /* We identified all the jump threading opportunities earlier, but could
9151 not transform the CFG at that time. This routine transforms the
9152 CFG and arranges for the dominator tree to be rebuilt if necessary.
9154 Note the SSA graph update will occur during the normal TODO
9155 processing by the pass manager. */
9157 finalize_jump_threads (void)
9159 thread_through_all_blocks (false);
9160 equiv_stack
.release ();
9164 /* Traverse all the blocks folding conditionals with known ranges. */
9171 values_propagated
= true;
9175 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nValue ranges after VRP:\n\n");
9176 dump_all_value_ranges (dump_file
);
9177 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
9180 substitute_and_fold (op_with_constant_singleton_value_range
,
9181 vrp_fold_stmt
, false);
9183 if (warn_array_bounds
)
9184 check_all_array_refs ();
9186 /* We must identify jump threading opportunities before we release
9187 the datastructures built by VRP. */
9188 identify_jump_threads ();
9190 /* Free allocated memory. */
9191 for (i
= 0; i
< num_vr_values
; i
++)
9194 BITMAP_FREE (vr_value
[i
]->equiv
);
9199 free (vr_phi_edge_counts
);
9201 /* So that we can distinguish between VRP data being available
9202 and not available. */
9204 vr_phi_edge_counts
= NULL
;
9208 /* Main entry point to VRP (Value Range Propagation). This pass is
9209 loosely based on J. R. C. Patterson, ``Accurate Static Branch
9210 Prediction by Value Range Propagation,'' in SIGPLAN Conference on
9211 Programming Language Design and Implementation, pp. 67-78, 1995.
9212 Also available at http://citeseer.ist.psu.edu/patterson95accurate.html
9214 This is essentially an SSA-CCP pass modified to deal with ranges
9215 instead of constants.
9217 While propagating ranges, we may find that two or more SSA name
9218 have equivalent, though distinct ranges. For instance,
9221 2 p_4 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_3, p_3 != 0>
9223 4 p_5 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_4, p_4 == q_2>;
9227 In the code above, pointer p_5 has range [q_2, q_2], but from the
9228 code we can also determine that p_5 cannot be NULL and, if q_2 had
9229 a non-varying range, p_5's range should also be compatible with it.
9231 These equivalences are created by two expressions: ASSERT_EXPR and
9232 copy operations. Since p_5 is an assertion on p_4, and p_4 was the
9233 result of another assertion, then we can use the fact that p_5 and
9234 p_4 are equivalent when evaluating p_5's range.
9236 Together with value ranges, we also propagate these equivalences
9237 between names so that we can take advantage of information from
9238 multiple ranges when doing final replacement. Note that this
9239 equivalency relation is transitive but not symmetric.
9241 In the example above, p_5 is equivalent to p_4, q_2 and p_3, but we
9242 cannot assert that q_2 is equivalent to p_5 because q_2 may be used
9243 in contexts where that assertion does not hold (e.g., in line 6).
9245 TODO, the main difference between this pass and Patterson's is that
9246 we do not propagate edge probabilities. We only compute whether
9247 edges can be taken or not. That is, instead of having a spectrum
9248 of jump probabilities between 0 and 1, we only deal with 0, 1 and
9249 DON'T KNOW. In the future, it may be worthwhile to propagate
9250 probabilities to aid branch prediction. */
9259 loop_optimizer_init (LOOPS_NORMAL
| LOOPS_HAVE_RECORDED_EXITS
);
9260 rewrite_into_loop_closed_ssa (NULL
, TODO_update_ssa
);
9263 insert_range_assertions ();
9265 to_remove_edges
.create (10);
9266 to_update_switch_stmts
.create (5);
9267 threadedge_initialize_values ();
9270 ssa_propagate (vrp_visit_stmt
, vrp_visit_phi_node
);
9273 free_numbers_of_iterations_estimates ();
9275 /* ASSERT_EXPRs must be removed before finalizing jump threads
9276 as finalizing jump threads calls the CFG cleanup code which
9277 does not properly handle ASSERT_EXPRs. */
9278 remove_range_assertions ();
9280 /* If we exposed any new variables, go ahead and put them into
9281 SSA form now, before we handle jump threading. This simplifies
9282 interactions between rewriting of _DECL nodes into SSA form
9283 and rewriting SSA_NAME nodes into SSA form after block
9284 duplication and CFG manipulation. */
9285 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa
);
9287 finalize_jump_threads ();
9289 /* Remove dead edges from SWITCH_EXPR optimization. This leaves the
9290 CFG in a broken state and requires a cfg_cleanup run. */
9291 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges
, i
, e
)
9293 /* Update SWITCH_EXPR case label vector. */
9294 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_update_switch_stmts
, i
, su
)
9297 size_t n
= TREE_VEC_LENGTH (su
->vec
);
9299 gimple_switch_set_num_labels (su
->stmt
, n
);
9300 for (j
= 0; j
< n
; j
++)
9301 gimple_switch_set_label (su
->stmt
, j
, TREE_VEC_ELT (su
->vec
, j
));
9302 /* As we may have replaced the default label with a regular one
9303 make sure to make it a real default label again. This ensures
9304 optimal expansion. */
9305 label
= gimple_switch_label (su
->stmt
, 0);
9306 CASE_LOW (label
) = NULL_TREE
;
9307 CASE_HIGH (label
) = NULL_TREE
;
9310 if (to_remove_edges
.length () > 0)
9311 free_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS
);
9313 to_remove_edges
.release ();
9314 to_update_switch_stmts
.release ();
9315 threadedge_finalize_values ();
9318 loop_optimizer_finalize ();
9325 return flag_tree_vrp
!= 0;
9328 struct gimple_opt_pass pass_vrp
=
9333 OPTGROUP_NONE
, /* optinfo_flags */
9334 gate_vrp
, /* gate */
9335 execute_vrp
, /* execute */
9338 0, /* static_pass_number */
9339 TV_TREE_VRP
, /* tv_id */
9340 PROP_ssa
, /* properties_required */
9341 0, /* properties_provided */
9342 0, /* properties_destroyed */
9343 0, /* todo_flags_start */
9348 | TODO_ggc_collect
/* todo_flags_finish */